Complete Biology 4th
Complete Biology 4th
Complete Biology 4th
Complete
Bio ogy
Fourth Edition
Ron Pickering
David Martindill
Mamta Nath
OXFORD
UNIVERSITY PRESS
Photo Library; pl 17: Biology Media/Science Photo Library;
OXFORD pl 18: Dr Gopal Murti/Science Photo Library; p132: Guang Niu/
Getty Images; p135: Arthur Glauberman/Science Photo Library;
UNIVERSITY PRBSS
p136: © Mark Edwards, Hard Rain Picture Library; p139(1): Dr.
Great Clarendon Street, Oxford, OX2 6DP, United Kingdom Gladden Willis, Visuals Unlimited/Science Photo Library; p139(r):
Kage Mikrofotografie Gbr/Science Photo Library; p142: rederic
Oxford University Press is a department of the University of SierakowskifShutterstock; p149: Cordelia Molloy/Science Photo
Oxford. Library; p161: imageBROKER/Shutterstock; p168(t): Metro-
It furthers the University's objective of excellence in research, Goldwyn-Mayer/Getty Images; p168(b): Rungroj Yongrit/EPA/
scholarship, and education by publishing worldwide. Oxford is a Shutterstock; pl 73(1): Sielan/Shutterstock; pl 73(r): Jared Wilson/
registered trade mark of Oxford University Press in the UK and in Shutterstock; pl 77: Nigel Cattlin/Alamy Stock Photo; p181:
certain other countries Dr Jeremy Burgess/Science Photo Library; p182(1): Guyerwood/
Bigstock; p182(c): Alan Marsh/Getty Image; p182(r): Zilli Roberto/
© Oxford University Press 2021 Dreamstime; p184: Marie C Fields/Shutterstock; p195: Giovanni
Cancemi/Shutterstock; p202(1): Shen max/Shutterstock; p202(c):
The moral rights of the authors have been asserted absolute-india/Shutterstock; p202(r): B E E R/Shutterstock;
p205: herjuafBigstock; p206: Steve Gschmeissner/Science Photo
First published in 2021 Library; p222: Tony Camacho/Science Photo Library; p224: CNRI/
Science Photo Library; p230(1): Cre8tive Images/Shutterstock;
All rights reserved. No part ofthis publication may be p230(r): Ed Reschke/Stone/Getty Images; p232(1): Buiten-Beeld/
reproduced, stored in a retrieval system, or transmitted, in Alamy Stock Photo; p232(r): Science Photo Library; p236: Agencja
any form or by any means, without the prior permission in Fotograficzna Caro/Alamy Stock Photo; p240: Marek Gucwa/
writing of Oxford University Press, or as expressly permitted Shutterstock; p242: Sue2020/Shutterstock; p247: Nigel Cattlin/
by law, by licence or under terms agreed with the appropriate Science Photo Library; p248: Lars S. Madsen/Alamy Stock Photo;
reprographics rights organization. Enquiries concerning p250: Carmine Arienzo/Shutterstock; p256: Zent/Dreamstime;
reproduction outside the scope of the above should be sent to the p267(t): Andrew Orlemann/123RF; p267(b): Rosanne Tackaberry/
Alamy Stock Photo; p268(t): Vitaly Titov/Shutterstock; p268(c):
Rights Department, Oxford University Press, at the address above. K. Sweet/Shutterstock; p268(bl): Kusumadireza/AP Images;
You must not circulate this work in any other form and you must p268(br): Franc;ois LOCHON/Gamma-Rapho/Getty Images; p272:
SHONE/Gamma-Rapho/Getty Images; p273: Paulo Oliveira/Alamy
impose this same condition on any acquirer
Stock Photo; p280(t): Tony mills/Alamy Stock Photo; p280(b):
British Library Cataloguing in Publication Data davemhuntphotography; p295(t): Cordelia Molloy/Science Photo
Library; p295(b): Tim Hazael/Science Photo Library; p297: David
Data available
Scharf/Science Photo Library; p298(t): Oxford University Press;
978-1-38-20057~0 (standard) p298(c): Oxford University Press; p298(b): Oxford University Press;
10987654321 p311: Ariel Skelley/DigitalVision{Getty Images.
978-1-38-200575-3 (enhanced)
10987654321 Artwork by Q2A Media Services Pvt. Ltd, Barking Dog Art,
Julian Baker, Jeff Edwards, Fakenham Photosetting, Ian Foulis &
Paper used in the production of this book is a natural, recyclable Associates, Roger Gorringe, Nick Hawken, ODI, David Pattinson,
product made from wood grown in sustainable forests. The and Haili Marie Verrinder.
manufacturing process conforms to the environmental
regulations of the country of origin.
Every effort has been made to contact copyright holders of
Printed in Italy by L.E.G.O. SpA material reproduced in this book. Any omissions will be rectified
in subsequent printings if notice is given to the publisher.
Dedication
For Nola, our darling granddaughter, who has already provided a
great deal of evidence that she has a scientist's inquisitive mind.
Acknowledgements
The publisher and authors would like to thank the following for
permission to use photographs and other copyright material:
Cover: Leena Robinson/Shutterstock.
Photos: p3: JavarmanfShutterstock; plO: AjayTvm/Shutterstock;
p14: Martin Fowler/Alamy Stock Photo; p15(t): AwaylGl/
Shutterstock; p15(b): Pulsar Imagens/Alamy Stock Photo; p22(1):
Dennis Kunkel Microscopy/Science Photo Library; p22(r): Garry
Delong/Science Photo Library; p24(t): Biophoto Associates/
Science Photo Library; p24(bl): Biology Pies/Science Source/
Science Photo Library; p24(br): Professors P. Motta & T. Naguro/
Science Photo Library; p28(t): Biophoto Associates/Science Photo
Library; p28(b): Biophoto Associates/Science Photo Library;
p33(1): Ed Reschke/Stone/Getty Images; p33(r): Clouds Hill
Imaging Ltd./Corbis Documentary/Getty Images; p38: Oxford
University Press; p59: Nigel Cattlin{Alamy Stock Photo; p68:
Amani A/Shutterstock; p69(t): Shutterstock; p69(b): WESLEY
BOCXE/Science Photo Library; p77: BSIP/UIG/Getty Images; p88:
Claude Nuridsany & Marie PerennoufScience Photo Library;
p86: Dr Jeremy Burgess/Science Photo Library; p93(tl): Slowfish/
Shutterstock; p93(tr): John Clegg/Science Photo Library; p93(b):
Olegusk/Shutterstock; p96(t): Daryl H/Shutterstock; p96(b):
Sebastien Burel/Shutterstock; p97: Ed Reschke/Stone/Getty
Images; p99(1): Adam Gault/Science Photo Library; p99(r): Eye Of
Science/Science Photo Library; p102: Steve Gschmeissner/Science
Photo Library; p103(1): Pr. H. Bezes/Cnri/Science Photo Library;
p103(r): Dr P. Marazzi/Science Photo Library; p110(t): Hans-
Ulrich Osterwalder/Science Photo Library; pl lO(c): Blickwinkel/
Alamy Stock Photo; p110(b): corlaffra/Shutterstock; pl 15(1):
Bill Gentile/The Image Bank Unreleased/Getty Image; p115(r):
Ariadne Van Zandbergen/Alamy Stock Photo; pl 16: Cnri/Science
Introduction iv Questions on photosynthesis and
plant nutrition 60
Characteristics and classification 7.1 Food and the ideal diet: carbohydrates,
of living organisms lipids and proteins 62
1.1 Biology is the study of life and 7.2 Food and the ideal diet: vitamins,
living organisms 2 minerals, water and fibre 64
1.2 The variety of life 4
7.3 Food is the fuel that drives the
processes of life 66
1.3 Fungi* 8
7.4 Balancing energy intake and demand:
1.4 Plants: the Plant Kingdom 10
problems causing malnutrition* 68
1.5 Invertebrate animals 12
7.5 More about malnutrition* 70
1.6 Vertebrate animals: five classes 14
7.6 Human nutrition converts food molecules
1.7 Protoctists and prokaryotes: often to a usable form 72
single celled 16
7.7 Ingestion provides food for the gut
1.8 Viruses 18 to work on 74
Questions on characteristics and 7.8 Digestion prepares useful food
classification 19 molecules for absorption 76
2.1 Organisms are made up of cells 22 7.9 Absorption and assimilation make
2.2 The organisation of living organisms 26 food available 80
Questions on cells and organisation 28 Questions on human nutrition
and health 83
Organisation and maintenance 8.1 Transport systems in plants 86
of organisms 8.2 Uptake of water and minerals by roots 88
8.3 Transpiration: water movement through
3.1 Movement in and out of cells: diffusion 30
the plant go
3.2 Movement in and out of cells: osmosis 32
8.4 The leaf and water loss 92
3.3 Movement in and out of cells: active
Questions on plants and water transport
transport 34
94
Questions on diffusion and osmosis 35
9.1 Transport systems in animals use blood
4.1 Biological molecules 36 as the transport medium 96
4.2 Testing for biochemicals 38 9.2 The circulatory system 100
5.1 Enzymes control biochemical reactions 9.3 Capillaries: materials are exchanged
in living organisms 40 between blood and tissues, and tissue
Questions on enzymes and fluid is formed 102
biological molecules 43 9.4 The heart is the pump for the
6.1 Photosynthesis and plant nutrition 46 circulatory system 104
6.2 The rate of photosynthesis 48 9.5 Coronary heart disease 106
6.3 Leaf structure and photosynthesis so Questions on circulation 108
6.4 The control of photosynthesis 52 10.1 Diseases and immunity 110
6.5 Control of photosynthesis by humans: 10.2 Pathogens are organisms that
use of greenhouses 54 cause disease 112
6.6 Photosynthesis and the environment 56 10.3 Preventing disease: safe food 113
6.7 Plants and minerals 58
iii
10.4 Individuals and the community can
fight disease together 114 Development of organisms and
10.5 Combating infection: blood and
the continuity of life
defence against disease 116
16.1 Reproduction is an important
10.6 Antibodies and the immune response 118 characteristic of living organisms 176
Questions on blood and defence 16.2 Reproduction in flowering plants:
against disease 120 flowers 178
11.1 Respiration provides the energy for life 122 16.3 Pollination: the transfer of male sex
11.2 Contraction of muscles requires energy cells to female flower parts 180
supplied by respiration 124 16.4 Fertilisation and the formation of seed
11.3 The measurement of respiration 126 and fruit 182
12.1 Gas exchange supplies oxygen 16.5 Germination of seeds 184
for respiration 128 Questions on plant reproduction
12.2 Breathing ventilates the lungs 130 and growth 186
Questions on exercise and breathing 133 16.6 Reproduction in humans 188
12.3 Smoking and disease* 134 16.7 The menstrual cycle 192
12.4 How do we know that smoking 16.8 Copulation and conception 194
causes disease?* 136 16.9 Pregnancy: the role of the placenta 196
Questions on respiration and gas 16.10 Pregnancy: development and
exchange 138 antenatal care* 198
13.1 Excretion: removal of the waste products 16.11 Birth and the newborn baby* 200
of metabolism 140 16.12 Sexually transmitted infections 203
13.2 Dialysis and the treatment of
Questions on human reproduction 204
kidney failure* 142
17.1 Variation and inheritance 206
14.1 Homeostasis: maintaining a constant
internal environment
17.2 DNA, proteins and the characteristics
144
of organisms 208
14.2 Control of body temperature 146
17.3 How the code is carried 210
14.3 Control of blood glucose 148
17.4 Cell division 212
Questions on excretion and homeostasis 150
17.5 More about cell division* 214
14.4 Coordination: the nervous system 154
17.6 Inheritance 218
14.5 Neurones can work together in
reflex arcs 156
17.7 Studying patterns of inheritance 220
iv
Organisms and their environment
20.8 Conservation efforts worldwide 280
19.1 Ecology and ecosystems 240 20.9 Conservation of resources: recycling
19.2 Flow of energy: food chains and water by treatment of sewage 282
food webs 242 20.10 Saving fossil fuels: fuel from
19.3 Feeding relationships: pyramids of fermentation 284
numbers, biomass and energy 246 20.11 Recycling: management of solid waste 286
19.4 Decay is a natural process 250 Questions on human impacts on
19.5 The carbon cycle 252 ecosystems 288
19.6 The nitrogen cycle 254 21.1 Bacteria are useful in biotechnology
and genetic engineering 292
19.7 Water is recycled too! 256
Questions on ecosystems, decay
21.2 Humans use enzymes from
microorga nisms 294
and cycles 258
19.8 Factors affecting population size 260
21.3 Baking and brewing: the economic
importance of yeast 298
19.9 Human population growth 262
Questions on biotechnology 299
20.1 Food supply: humans and agriculture 264
21.4 Genetic engineering 300
20.2 Land use for agriculture 266
21.5 Gene transfer in higher organisms 302
20.3 Damage to ecosystems: malnutrition
Questions on genetic engineering 305
and famine 268
Practical assessment 306
20.4 Human impacts on the environment:
Laboratory equipment 308
pollution 270
Measurement of variables 310
20.5 Pollution of water: eutrophication 274
Enzyme experiments and the
20.6 Humans can have a positive effect on
scientific method 312
the environment: conservation of species 276
Mathematical skills 314
20.7 Managing fish stocks: science and the Index 316
fishing industry 278
V
Biology is the study of life and living organisms. During the past few
hundred years, biology has changed from concentrating on the structure of
living organisms (often by examining dead specimens!) to looking more at
how they work or function. Over the past thirty years or so biologists have
begun to understand how the molecules which make up the bodies of living
organisms are responsible for this function. We have discovered much about
health and disease, about the interactions of different organisms forming
communities, about the genes which control the activities of our bodies,
and how humans can affect the lives of other organisms. These advances
in biological knowledge raise many issues. We need to understand how
our activities affect the environment, how humans can take responsibility
for their own health and welfare, and how we must make rules for the
appropriate use of our genetic information.
In this book you will study a range of living organisms, the life processes they
carry out, the effects that these life processes might have on our health, and
the responsibilities which we have towards other organisms.
This book has been organised to help you find information quickly and easily.
It is written in double-page units - each is a topic which forms part of the
IGCSE syllabus - and there is also a practical assessment section that will
alert you to the mathematical skills required.
- 8
10
- The Plant Kingdom
Invertebrate animals
1.3
1.3/1.4
12 Vertebrate animals: five classes 1.3/1.4
14 Protoctists/ Bacteria 1.3
- 16
18
- Viruses/ questions/ Questions on keys
Questions on classification
11.3/1.4
1.4
20 : Organisms are made of cells 2.1
22 Structures within the cytoplasm / Cell structure 2.1/2.3
,- -
24 1The organisation of living organisms 2.2
26 Questions on cells and organisation 2.1/2.2/2.3
28 Movement in and out of cells: diffusion 3.1
- 30
32
- Movement in and out of cells: osmosis
Active transport/ Movement in and out of cells
3.2
3.3
- 34
36
- j All living things are made up of organic molecules
Testing for biochemicals
- 14.1
I 4.1
- 38
40
- Enzymes control biochemical reactions
Questions on enzymes/molecules
I 5.1
5.1
l
-
,___
42
44
- Photosynthesis and ~lant nutrition
The rate of photosynthesis
6.1
6.1
46 I Leaf structure and photosynthesis 6.2
48 The control of photosynthesis 6.1
50
- Control by humans: greenhouses ~
52 Photosynthesis and the environment 6.1
54 Plants and minerals 6.3
vii
Page number Unit title IGCSE Syllabus section
56 Questions on photosynthesis 6.1 /6.2/6.3
58 Food and the ideal diet: carbohydrates, lipids and proteins 7.1
60 Food and the ideal diet: minerals, water and fibre 7.1
62 Food is the fuel that drives the processes of life 7.1/12.1
64 Problems causing malnutrition 7.1
66 More about malnutrition 7.1
68 Animal nutrition converts food molecules into a useable 7.2
form
70 Ingestion provides food for the gut to work on 7.3
72 Digestion provides useful food molecules for digestion 7.4
74 ... more digestion ... 7.4
76 Absorption and assimilation make food available 7.5
78 Questions on nutrition and health
80 Uptake of water and minerals by roots 8.2
82 Transport systems in plants 8.1 /8.3/8.4
84 Transpiration: water movement through the plant 8.3
86 The leaf and water loss 8.3/18.2
88 Questions on plants and water
90 Transport systems in animals use blood as the transport 9.1
medium
92 ... .functions of the blood 9.4
94 The circu latory system 9.3
96 Capillaries 9.3
98 The heart is the pump for the circulatory system 9.2
100 Coronary heart disease 9.2
102 Questions on animal transport
104 Health and disease 10.1
106 Pathogens are organisms that cause disease / Preventing 10.1
disease: safe food
108 Individuals and the community can fight disease together 10.1
110 Combating infection: blood and defence against disease 10.1
112 Antibodies and the immune response 10.1
114 Applications of immunology/ Defence against disease 10.1
116 Respiration provides the energy for life 12.1/12.2
118 Contraction of muscles requires energy from respiration 12.3
120 The measurement of respiration 12.1/12.2
122 Gas exchanqe supplies oxyqen for respiration 11.1
124 Breathing ventilates the lungs 11.1
126 Exercise and breathing / Gas exchange 11.1
128 Smoking and disease 15.3
130 How do we know that smoking causes disease 15.3
132 Questions on respiration
134 Excretion 13.1
136 Dialysis and the treatment of kidney disease 13.1
138 Homeostasis 14.4
140 Control of body temperature 14.4
142 Control of blood glucose concentration 14.4
144 Questions on excretion and homeostasis
146 Coordination: the nervous system 14.1
viii
Page number Unit title IGCSE Syllabus section
148 Neurones and the reflex arc 14.1
150 Integration by the CNS 14.1
152 Receptors and senses 14.2
154 .... rods and cones ... 14.2
156 Questions on sense organs
158 The endocrine system 14.3
160 ... adrenaline .. ./ Drugs/questions on hormones 14.3
162 Sensitivity and movement in plants 14.5
164 ... gravitropism ... 14.5
166 Drugs and disorders of the nervous system 15.1/15.2/15.3
168 ... alcohol. .. 15.1/15.2/15.3
170 Reproduction is an important characteristic. ..... 16.1/16.2
172 Reproduction in flowering plants - flowers 16.3
174 Pollination 16.3
176 Ferti Iisation ... 16.3
178 Germination of seeds 16.3
180 Questions on plant reproduction
182 Reproduction in humans 16.4/16.5
184 More - gametes 16.4
186 The menstrual cycle 16.5
188 Copulation and conception 16.4
190 Contraception 16.6
192 Pregnancy: the role of the placenta 16.4
194 Pregnancy : antenatal care 16.4
196 Birth and the newborn baby 16.4
198 Twins/ Sexually transmitted infections 16.4/16.7
200 Questions on human reproduction
202 Variation and inheritance 17.1/18.1
204 DNA, proteins and characteristics 17.2
206 How the code is carried 17.2
208 Cell division 17.3/17.4
210 Stem cells/ Questions on cell division 17.3
212 Inheritance 17.5
214 Studying patterns of inheritance 17.5
216 Inherited medical conditions and co-dominance 17.5
218 Sex is determined by X and Y chromosomes 17.5
220 Questions on inheritance
222 Variation 18.1
224 Causes of variation 18.1
226 Variation and natural selection 18.3
228 Natural selection 18.3
230 Artificia I selection 18.3
232 Questions on variation
234 Ecology and ecosystems 19.1/19.2
236 Flow of energy 19.1/19.2
238 Humans and food webs 19.2
240 Feeding relationships: Pyramids ... 19.2
242 Ecological counting/sampling 19.2/19.4
244 Decay is a natural process 19.3
ix
Page number Unit title IGCSE Syllabus section
246 The carbon cycle 19.3
248 The nitrogen cycle 19.3
250 Water is recycled too! 19.3
252 Questions on ecosystems, decay and cycles
254 Factors affecting population size 19.4
256 Human population growth 19.4
258 Bacteria are useful...... 20.1
260 Humans use enzymes from ..... 20.2
262 Investigations on enzymes useful to humans 20.2
264 Using fungi to produce antibiotics 20.2
266 Bakinq and brewinq / Questions on biotechnoloqy 20.2
268 Genetic engineering 20.3
270 Gene transfer in higher organisms 20.3
272 More genes/questions
274 Food supply: humans and agriculture / Intensive farming 21.1
276 Land use for agriculture 21.1/21.2
278 Malnutrition and famine 21.1
280 Human impacts: pollution 21.3
282 Radioactive pollution 21.3
284 Pollution of water 21.3
286 Conservation of species 21.4
288 Managing fish stocks 21.4
290 Conservation efforts worldwide 21.4
292 Recycling water: sewage treatment 21.4
294 Saving fossil fuels 21.4
296 Recycling solid waste 21.4
297 Questions on human impacts on the environment
300 Practical assessment Appendix
302 Laboratory equipment Appendix
304 Measurement of variables Appendix
306 Enzyme experiments and the scientific method Appendix
308 Handling data Appendix
X
The end-of-section questions in this book include examples of those
testing AOl, A02 and A03. Your teacher will help you to attempt
questions of all types. You can see from the above table that it will not
be enough to try only 'recall' questions.
All candidates take three papers.
The make-up of each assessment programme is shown below:
Core assessment
Questions are based on Core content.
Paper 1: Multiple Choice (Core), 45 mins Paper 3: Theory (Core), 1 hour 15 mins
There are a total of 40 marks available, worth There are a total of 80 marks available, worth
25% of your IGCSE. The paper consists of 50% of your IGCSE. The paper consists of
multiple-choice questions. compulsory short-answer and structured
questions.
You will be tested in AO1 and AO2 and can You will be tested in AO1 and AO2 and can
achieve a grade C to G. achieve a grade C to G.
Extended assessment
Questions are based on the Core and Supplement subject content.
Paper 2: Multiple Choice (Extended), 45 mins Paper 4: Theory (Extended), 1 hour 15 mins
There are a total of 40 marks available, worth There are a total of 80 marks available, worth
25% of your IGCSE. The paper consists of 50% of your IGCSE. The paper consists of
multiple-choice questions. compulsory short-answer and structured
questions.
You will be tested in AO1 and AO2 and can You will be tested in AO1 and AO2 and can
achieve a grade A* to G achieve a grade A* to G.
Practical assessment
Students take either Paper S or Paper 6.
Paper 5: Practical Test, 1 hour 15 mins Paper 6: Alternative to Practical, 1 hour 15 mins
There are a total of 40 marks available, worth There are a total of 40 marks available, worth
25% of your IGCSE. You will be required to do 25% of your IGCSE. You will NOT be required
experiments in a lab as part of the assessment. to do experiments in a lab as part of the
assessment.
You will be tested in AO3 and can achieve a You will be tested in AO3 and can achieve a
grade A* to G. grade A* to G.
I hope that you enjoy using this book, and that it helps you to understand the
world of biology. You, like every other living organism, are a part of this world
- perhaps one day you will find yourself working to help others to understand
more about it.
xi
.
CHARACTERISTICS AND CLASSIFICATION OF LIVING ORGANISMS
Depending on energy
The organisation in living things and their ability to carry out their life
processes depends on a supply of energy. Many biologists today define life
as a set of processes that result from the organisation of matter and which
depend on the expenditure of energy.
In this book we shall see:
■ how energy is released from food molecules and trapped in a usable form
■ how molecules are organised into the structures of living organisms
■ how living organisms use energy to drive their life processes.
1. Nutrition: the taking in of
materials for energy, growth and
development. Plants require light,
carbon dioxide, water and ions and
make their foods using the process of
photosynthesis. Animals require
organic compounds and ions (and
usually water) and obtain their foods
'ready made' by eating them.
® 1 Approximately how many years passed between the formation of the Earth and the appearance of the first living
organisms?
0 What sort of molecules do you think might have been present in the primordial soup?
3 RINGER is a word that helps people remember the characteristics of living organisms. Think of your own word
to help you remember these characteristics.
4 Suggest two ways in wh ich reproduction is essential to living organisms.
3
.
CHARACTERISTICS AND CLASSIFICATION OF LIVING ORGANISMS
Classification keys
Taxonomists (people who study classification) place organisms into
groups by asking questions about their characteristics, such as 'Does
the organism photosynthesise?' or 'Does the organism contain many
cells?'. A series of questions like this is called a classification key.
Examples of such keys are shown below and on the opposite page.
s The characteristics of living organisms used to make classification
keys have traditionally been based on morphology and anatomy
(the shape and structure of organisms) because this was what the
scientists could easily observe and measure.
YES Go to question 2
1 Does the organism have cells with a definite nucleus?
NO It is a prokaryote
YES Go to question 3
2 Is the organism made up of many different cells?
NO It is a protoctistan
YES Go to question 4
3 Is the organism a heterotroph?
NO It is a plant
4 Does the organism have cell walls and does it feed by YES It is a fungus
external digestion? NO It is an animal
.A.. A key may be used to place an organism in one of the five kingdoms
4
CHARACTERISTICS AND CLASSIFICATION OF LIVING ORGANISMS
s
► This kind of key, with only two answers to
each question (in this case, YES or NO), is
called a dichotomous key ('dichotomous' All living organisms
means branching). It can be written as a
branching or spider key, using the same The five kingdoms
questions: Prokaryotes
Protoctistans
Plants
Fungi
1 Does the organism have cells with a definite nucleus? Animals
---------· ·---------
YES NO
_______ .. ________
does it feed by external digestion?
_. .__
It is a plant
drawn out. For this reason the listed
form of a dichotomous key like the
one shown opposite is usually used
YES NO for identification of organisms outside
the laboratory.
It is a fungus It is an animal
Five kingdoms
Using the key above, it is possible to place any living organism into
one of five very large groups. These groups, distinguished from one
another by obvious characteristics of morphology and anatomy,
are called the five kingdoms. Each of these kingdoms contains an
enormous number of different species, and keys can be used within
a kingdom to place any individual species into further groups. The
diagram on the next page shows the names of these groups, and how
the lion is classified within the Animal Kingdom.
Hierarchy of classification*
The sequence of kingdom, phylum, class, order, family, genus and
species is called a hierarchy of classification.
Notice that each classification group is given a name. Lions belong
to the class Mammalia and the order Carnivora, for example. The
final two group names are written in italics -this is a worldwide
convention amongst scientists. The lion is called simba in Swahili,
5
1.2 The variety of life
Organisms that are closely related have very similar DNA profiles - humans and
chimpanzees, for example, share 98.6% of their genes!
For example:
Bra nchi ng key
All objects
.
With t hreads W it hout threads
®
1 State which of the following is the best definition 0rhe scientific name for the human is Homo sapiens.
of classification. State the meaning of this name.
a Giving every organism a name 6 The table below lists some of the characteristics of
b Arranging organisms into groups living organisms.
c Describing the external features of organisms a Match each characteristic with its definition. Write
d Identifying all living organisms the letter and number to show your answer, for
2 State which of the following is the correct binomial example, a-4.
name for the English oak (a species of oak tree).
Characteristic Definition
a Quercus robur
b Quercus Robur a excretion 1 the ability to detect changes in the
environment
c quercus robur
d QUERCUS ROBUR b nutrition 2 processes that make more of the same
organism
3 Arrange these classification groups in order of size
(from the largest to the smallest): c sensitivity 3 remova l of the waste products of
metabolism
class, family, genus, kingdom, order, phylum, species.
4 The scientific names for the weasel and mink are d reproduction 4 taking into the body of materials for
energy, growth and development
Mustela nivalis and Mustela vison, respectively. Both of
these animals belong to the order Carnivora, as do the b Suggest why many biologists believe that respiration
fox (Vulpes vulpes) and otter (Lutra /utra) . The otter, is the most significant characteristic of a living
mink and weasel all belong to the family Mustelidae. organism.
a Which feature must they have in common to belong
to the order Carnivora?
b Which two animals are most closely related?
c Which animal is the most different from the other
three?
d Suggest one feature that places all of these
organisms in the Animal Kingdom.
7
.
CHARACTERISTICS AND CLASSIFICATION OF LIVING ORGANISMS
Requirements of fungi
Fungi have very similar requirements to those of bacteria, that is:
■ a moist environment, so that they can absorb the soluble products
of digestion of their food source in solution
■ a warm environment, so that enzymes can work at their optimum
temperature
■ a nutrient source to provide the raw materials and energy required
for growth.
Fungi do not require light because they do not rely on photosynthesis
for the production of food compounds. This means that fungi are
rarely found in light environments, because such environments are
usually too warm and dry for fungal growth.
8
CHARACTERISTICS AND CLASSIFICATION OF LIVING ORGANISMS
9
.
CHARACTERISTICS AND CLASSIFICATION OF LIVING ORGANISMS
s Ferns
To recall that all plants are autotrophs, and are Ferns are much better adapted to life on land than
able to absorb light energy to drive photosynthesis mosses. They have roots, stems, complex leaves and
■ To understand some of the steps in the adaptation vascular tissues. They are able to produce spores for
of plants to life on dry land wide dispersal. However, they do not have very thick
■ To recall the characteristics of two main plant cuticles and can only survive in shady, humid areas.
groups The gametes of ferns, like those of mosses, must
swim through a film of moisture to reach the site of
Plants are autotrophs fertilisation. An example of a fem is described below.
As autotrophs, plants manufacture food
molecules from simple, inorganic sources by Angiosperms
the process of photosynthesis using light as a The angiosperms or flowering plants are the most
source of energy. Plants all contain the light- successful of plants - they have evolved into many
absorbing pigment chlorophyll (or similar species and have colonised almost every available
molecules which perform the same function) habitat. More than 80% of all plants are angiosperms
inside cells which have a definite cellulose cell (plants with enclosed seeds). Many features of the
wall. lives of flowering plants are covered elsewhere in this
book (see pages 46-59, 86-93, 170-173 and 178- 185,
Adaptations to life on land for example). The diagram at the top of the opposite
The first plants lived in water, but as living page summarises these features, and emphasises the
organisms evolved, plant forms developed that adaptations of flowering plants to a successful life on
could live on land. The classification of plants land, including warmer habitats.
into groups follows this sequence of evolution.
Two groups of angiosperms
The Plant Kingdom may be divided into three
There are two major subgroups within the
main groups (phyla): mosses, ferns and seed
angiosperms. In one group, there is a single
plants.
cotyledon in the seed (see page 183) - these are
Mosses cannot grow far away from water, but the monocotyledons. In the other group, there
ferns and flowering plants (angiosperms) are are two cotyledons - these are the dicotyledons
much better adapted to life on land. (eudicotyledons). There are other differences between
monocotyledons and dicotyledons, as shown in the
These sporangia have been used as diagram on the next page.
a medicine to cause violent peristalsis
in humans - this is one way to Groups of
remove tapeworms from the gut! sporangia w hich
produce and ◄ Ferns have
release spores. complex
Frond - a complex
leaf, with conducting
tubes.
CJ leaves,
vascular
tissues and
- - - - Stem contains phloem
true roots.
and xylem, though the They
tubes are short w it hout
Young fronds are - - -- ••r reproduce by
alw ays rolled up.
produci ng
Simple, true roots - - - - - - i i Rhizome - underground Spores. A Each brown patch on the underside
for anchorage and stem that can survive
absorption. when fronds die. of the leaf is made up of many sporangia,
which produce and release spores
10
CHARACTERISTICS AND CLASSIFICATION OF LIVING ORGANISMS
Flowers- the colour, pattern, shape, scent _ _ _ _-11J"~ - -The ovary protects the ovules and developing
or nectar of the flower can attract insects, embryo, particularly from drying out.
birds or mammals. ('Angiosperm' means 'enclosed seed'.)
Large leaf surface allows high,_ __ .,,._ _ _ _ Fruits are formed from ripened ovaries.
rate of photosynthesis to supply Their specialised shapes, colours, smells and text ures aid
energy for growth and fruit seed dispersal by wind, water and animals.
production. However, water losses
by evaporat ion and diffusion
t hrough stomata are high.
11
.
CHARACTERISTICS AND CLASSIFICATION OF LIVING ORGANISMS
Crustacea
Crabs are slightly unusual because many of their
To know the difference between a vertebrate
segments are tucked under their body.
animal and an invertebrate animal
■ To be able to distinguish between different Hardened, serrated edge to claw:
can hold onto slippery food, and
classes of arthropods
break open shells of molluscs.
■ To understand the importance of metamorphosis
in insects
Jointed limbs: flexible Eyes: important
sensors in aquatic
to help with feeding.
Vertebrates and invertebrates environment.
All animals share one characteristic - they
feed on organic molecules (see page 36).
Members of the Animal Kingdom can be
divided into two large groups based on
whether they have a backbone as part of
a bony skeleton. Animals with a backbone
are called vertebrates and those without a
backbone are called invertebrates.
Arthropods Carapace: a thick,
Gills under shell: hardened shell for
The arthropods are the most numerous of protection against
allow uptake of
all animals, both in terms of the number oxygen from water. predators.
of different species and the number of
individuals in any one species. The insects
are arthropods that show an interesting Myriapods
adaptation in their life cycle called Antennae: these are important Mouthparts: have hard
metamorphosis that allows them to use the sense organs in the edges for biting vegetation
millipedes' dark, damp (millipedes) or other
resources of their habitat to the maximum.
environment. ~ animals (centipedes).
1/
Apart from insects, the arthropod phylum
includes three other classes - arachnids
(spiders, for example), crustaceans (crabs,
for example) and myriapods (millipedes and
centipedes). The diagrams on the opposite ~ ,-- Hard exoskeleton:
Many body segments:
page compare insects and spiders. Amongst body is flexible for protection against
the arthropods, insects and spiders are movement and predators.
12
CHARACTERISTICS AND CLASSIFICATION OF LIVING ORGANISMS
Insects
e.g. blowfly, mosquito
The body is segmented, with the
segments grouped into
,--=....-,r-_ _ The pupa is formed when the
head, thorax and abdomen. larva moults (sheds its skin).
I The pupa has a hard outer case
inside which the tissues of the
larva are reorganised into
adult tissues.
@
Arachnids 1 Copy and complete the following
paragraph.
Head and thorax are combined into Powerful, piercing jaws All animals have one common
one body part. - - - - - - - - - - ~- all spiders are predators.
characteristic - - -· The invertebrates
are animals that do not have - -·
Simple eyes (but more than one
are the most numerous of all
pair) help to detect prey.
animals.
Fish
Scales Lateral line contains sense
■ To know the characteristics of the vertebrates covered in mucus help organs to detect vibration.
streamlining for
■ To understand how different classes of swimming.
vertebrates show increasing adaptation to dry
land
■ To know the five classes of vertebrate, and to
provide examples of each
r
11
Scales on skin?
7
__IL
Amphibians
YES NO
Reptiles
Dry, scaly skin -
limits water loss.
Tail can be used
for swimming,
as in crocodiles.
Limbs efficient
for crawling
and climbing.
bony ridges
• The crocodile has the typical dry scaly skin of reptiles.
to aid feeding.
The eyes on the top of its head and its sharp, pointed teeth
adapt it for catching prey in water.
Birds
Forelimbs are Nostril, leading to lungs, which • The heron has typical bird features of feathers and a
modified as wings. are the organs of gas exchange. beak. It is well adapted to capture fish and frogs as it has
large eyes to spot its prey, a long pointed beak to grab its
prey and large feet for walking over soft, muddy ground.
OBJECTIVES Protoctists
This is a kingdom with many members of different types. They
■ To know the structure of a
are placed in the Protoctistans Kingdom because they do not fit
protoctist
anywhere else! All protoctists have cells with nuclei and may have
■ To know the structure of a
other organelles such as chloroplasts. Many are unicellular and some
bacterial cell, an example
of a prokaryote are multicellular. Some feed like animals, others can photosynthesise
and there are even some, like Euglena, which can do both. Unicellular
■ To know the difference
between a protoctist and a protoctists include Plasmodium, which is the parasitic organism that
prokaryote causes malaria. Algae are classified as protoctists; they vary in size
from tiny unicellular organisms to giant seaweeds.
Tips!
Remember: if a unicellular Cell membrane
organism has a nucleus, then it
is a protoctist and not a
prokaryote.
Cytoplasm
Feeding groove
A Paramecium
- - Chloroplast
Eye spot
- - - - Cytoplasm
A Euglena
16
CHARACTERISTICS AND CLASSIFICATION OF LIVING ORGANISMS
0 Cocci (singular
Glycogen grains
may be a food store.
0 coccus) are
spherical
bacteria.
Staphylococcus Pneumococcus
Cytoplasm contains enzymes and Slime coat is present (causes boils) (pneumonia)
food molecules but no organelles. in some species.
0. 1 µm
I I
Bacilli (singular
Cell wall does not
bacillus) are rod-
contain cell ulose.
shaped bacteria.
® 1 True or false?
a Bacteria contain a nucleus, although it is smaller than an animal cell nucleus.
b All bacteria are parasites.
17
.
CHARACTERISTICS AND CLASSIFICATION OF LIVING ORGANISMS
s Viruses
OBJECTIVES When the five-kingdom system of classification was devised, no
■ To know the structure one was able to find a place for the group of organisms called the
of a virus viruses. This is because viruses do not show the typical features
■ To know that viruses of living things - respiration, nutrition and reproduction, for
can only live and example - unless they are inside the cells of another living organism.
reproduce inside the In other words, all viruses are parasites and therefore cause harm to
cells of another living their host. Some taxonomists have suggested that viruses belong in a
organism sixth kingdom. There is great variation in the structure of viruses, but
■ To know the differences they all have certain common features. The structure of a typical virus
between bacteria and is shown below.
viruses
Most viruses cause disease - they may infect humans, domestic
animals or plants. The virus COVID-19 is responsible for a severe
respiratory illness. The virus is called a coronavints because when
viewed under the electron microscope the spikes which stick out from
the protein coat look like a crown (corona = crown in Latin).
®1 True or false?
a All viruses cause disease.
b Viruses can only reproduce inside living cells.
c All viruses are the same shape.
d Viruses are made up of a protein coat surrounding double-stranded DNA or RNA.
18
Questions on characteristics and
classification
1 Butterflies are insects for which of the 4 The table below lists some of the characteristics
following reasons? of groups of living organisms.
A Because they lay eggs a Match each description with its
B Because they can fly classification group. Write the letter and
C Because they have three main body parts number to show your answer, for example,
D Because they feed on nectar [ 1] a-4.
5 Use the key to identify the five fish shown in the drawings. Write
down the letter of each fish and its name.
[4]
Key
\
1. One dorsal fin 2
Two dorsal fins 4
R
2. Barbels 3
(fleshy extensions at
corners of mouth)
No barbels at Phoxinus
corners of mouth phoxinus
3. Four barbels Barbus barbus
19
CHARACTERISTICS AND CLASSIFICATION OF LIVING ORGANISMS
Specimen 2
Specimen 1
Specimen 3
Specimen 4
Specimen 5
20
Keys and classification
LIVING ORGANISMS A key enables identification of an organism by
* indicates the FIVE KINGDOMS observation of its characteristics. Close observation
lQ2 allows a series of questions (the branch points in
r I this key) to be answered, eventually leading to
Made up of Made up of the organism being studied.
single cells many cells
lcv '@
Cells have an
Cells have Cells have Cells have
obvious cell wall
no obvious an obvious no cell wall
nucleus nucleus ANIMALS* I@
r I
Cells contain chlorophyll in Cells do not contain
PROKARYOTE* PROTOCTISTANS * chloroplasts (so organism chlorophyll (so organism n
e.g. Salmonella e.g. Plasmodium I
feeds by photosynthesis) feeds by absorption) )>
PLANTS* ::0
)>
FUNGI* e.g. n
@ I@ bread mould --;
m
::0
® (j) ,-....,
(/)
Organism has Segmented body Soft body with Organism has No separate Stem, leaves Stem, leaves --;
,-....,
hard exoskeleton, with chaetae no limbs - covered internal skeleton, root, stem but no roots and roots
and leaves
n
jointed limbs, (bristles) by shell non-segmented body (/)
~
n
Spores Seeds
® produced produced
'
)>
(/)
(/)
,-....,
FERNS SEED PLANTS -.,
Three body Two pairs of Two body No covering on Skin covering ,-....,
segments (head, antennae segments (head- skin (smooth, e.g. oak tree n
)>
thorax, abdomen) thorax, abdomen) moist skin) --;
,-....,
Three pairs of legs Four pairs of legs
0
Two pairs of wings No wings AMPH IBIANS z
9
Antennae e.g. frog 0
-.,
Scales on skin No scales on skin
I
'
~ l@ '<
INSECTS CRUSTACEANS SPIDERS ,-....,
The size of a structure or an organism is measured in units of length (such as mm or m). When a diagram is made, or a photograph
taken, it may not be easy to directly show the correct size - for example, when a structure is extremely small or very large. The correct (or
true) size of an organism can be calculated using a combination of actual measurement and a known magnification.
Sec.retory vesicles Cytoplasm of animal cells Vacuoles are small Glycogen is the
containing cell products is often denser, w ith many and temporary. They can sto ra ge form
such as ho rmones o r more organelles and be involved wit h digest io n of carbohydrat es.
enzymes are much dissolved substances. (e.g. in phagocytes)
mo re common in o r wit h excretion
animal cells. (contractile vacuoles may
remove excess w ater).
ant and animal cells Cell surface membrane Nucleus contains the
ave common features surrounds t he cytoplasm. genet ic material (DNA which
hich relate to maintaining It contro ls t he entry and exit makes up genes on the
e characteristics of life. of disso lved substances and chromosomes). This carries
~ the coded instructions for
separates t he cell's contents
from its surroundin gs. controlling t he activities and
Do not confuse the cell characteristics of the cell.
wall with the cell surface The chromosomes only become
membrane. visible during cell division.
Chloroplasts contain Large permanent vacuole Starch (in t he cytoplasm Cellulose cell wall
the pigment chlorophyll contai ns water necessary or t he chloro plast s) provides structural support
(for light absorption) and to provide turgor pressure is the storage form (pressure of cell contents leads
the enzymes necessary and may store ions of carbohydrat es. to turgidity) and protects agai nst
for the production of and molecules. damage caused by osmot ic
glucose by photosynthesis. intake of w ater. The cell wall is
freely permeable to water
and dissolved substances.
.&. The features of plant and animal cells allow these cells to carry out the basic processes
of life. The differences between plant and animal cells are due to the differences in
lifestyle between animals and plants, especially to thei r different methods of nutrition.
23
2.1 Organisms are made up of cells
Mitochondrion
Rough
endoplasmic
reticulum
Cell investigations
Plant cells
An onion cut in half
1 Use a razor to cut a small piece out of an
onion leaf. Use forceps to peel skin off the
inner surface of the leaf. Put the skin into a
Petri dish of water. '"""·..--~ Inner fleshy
food-storage
2 Put a drop of iod ine solution onto a slide. Put
leaves
a sma ll piece of the onion skin (less than 5 Tra nsparent skin
mm) into the solution and smooth it out so from kidney surface
there are no folds . Lower a coverslip over it, /
taking care not to trap any bubbles. Prepare
another slide in the same way but using water
instead of the iodine solution.
Kidney
3 Study the stained onion cells under the low,
medium and high power of a microscope, /
then look at unstained cells. What parts of the
cell have become stained?
Animal cells
4 Use a razor and forceps to peel pieces of
--- Skin pu lled
from inner
surface of leaf
I
Forceps
transparent skin off the outside of a kidney. Make a slide of the skin in water, and another in iodine.
5 Study stained and unstained cells. How are they different?
6 Draw plant and anima l cells and list their similarities and differences.
2 MEASURING CELLS
® 1 An onion is a bulb, rather like a daffodil. The bulb sends up a shoot with a flower at the tip.
Assume that the shoot is 25 cm tall. Calculate the smallest number of onion cells which
would reach along this length. (First convert 25 cm to mm).
0 Onion cells stay still when you are examining them under a microscope. Think of trying to
examine a small moving single-celled animal. Suggest how you could slow down the
movement of the animal and so make measurement easier.
25
.
CHARACTERISTICS AND CLASSIFICATION OF LIVING ORGANISMS
Specialised cells
Large organism s are multicellular - they are
To understand that the body of a living organism
is a highly organised structure m ade up of many cells. Different types of cell
have particular structures designed to help them
■ To understand that cells, tissues, organs and systems
represent increasing degrees of organisation in living carry out different tasks and functions - they have
organisms become specialised. Some examples of specialised
cells, and their functions, are shown in the table.
Animal cells
Red blood cell (page 96) Transports oxygen from the lungs to the tissues where aerobic
respiration occurs. The cytoplasm is filled with the pigment
haemoglobin, which carries oxygen. The cells have no nucleus, leaving
more space for haemoglobin, and they are very flexible (they can be
forced through even the narrowest of blood vessels).
Ciliated cell (page 129) Has a layer of tiny hairs (cilia) which can move and push mucus
from one place to another. The mucus can transport trapped dust and
microbes when it is pushed by the cilia.
Motor nerve cell (page 157) Conducts nerve impulses. The cell has a long fibre called an
axon along which impulses travel, a fatty sheath which gives electrical
insulation, and a many-branched ending which can connect with many
other cells.
Other important specialised animal cells are the gametes, sperm and egg (page 190). These are specialised for fusion to form a zygote.
The sperm (male) is able to swim and the ovum (female) has a large food store. Each of them has the haploid number of chromosomes.
Plant cells
Root hair cell Absorbs minerals and water from the soil water. The cell has a
long extension (a root hair) which increases the surface area for the
absorption of materials.
•
Xylem vessel Transports water and supports the plant. The cell has no
cytoplasm (so water can pass freely), no end wall (so that many cells
can form a continuous tube) and walls strengthened with a waterproof
substance called lignin.
Another important specialised plant cell is the palisade mesophyll cell (page 50). This cell has many chloroplasts and a shape that allows many
of them to pack together in the regions of highest light intensity for the maximum absorption of light energy.
26
CHARACTERISTICS AND CLASSIFICATION OF LIVING ORGANISMS
... tissues combine to form organs ... Epithelial cells Smooth muscle cells
Cell
• Tissue:
•
• Organ:
group of tissues, working
Sma ll intestine
Human
27
1 Arrange these biological terms in order of size Glycogen granule
(from the smallest to the largest): [3]
Large, permanent vacuole
organ, cell, organism, organelle, tissue, system. Mitochondrion
Ribosome on endoplasmic reticulum
2 Arrange these units of length in order, starting
with the largest and ending with the smallest: [10]
kilometre, micrometre, metre, millimetre. [2] 5 The table below describes some cell structures.
Match each structure with its description. Write
An average plant cell is SO micrometres
the letter and number to show your answer, for
long. How many plant cells could fit into one
millimetre? Show your working. [2] example, a-4.
Structure Description
3 Look at these photomicrographs (photographs
taken through a microscope). a Cell membrane 1 Structures which contain chlorophyll
b Cell wall 2 Cavity found only in plant cells
--~
3 Surrounds a plant cell and contains
c Chloroplasts
cellulose
d Cytoplasm 4 Main site of protein synthesis
e Mitochondria 5 Sites of aerobic respiration
I 12µm I
f Endoplasmic reticulum 6 Controls entry and exit of substances
Epithelial cell
7 Carries genetic information and
g Nucleus
controls cell activities
h Vacuole 8 Site of anaerobic respiration
[7]
6 The following diagrams show six cells. One of
35µm I
1 the cells transports oxygen in the blood. This
Palisade cell cell does not contain a nucleus.
a List three differences between the epithelial a i Give the letter of the cell that transports
and palisade cells, and three common oxygen in the blood. [ 1]
features which they share. Why are there ii State the function of the nucleus in
differences between these cells? [7] most cells. [ 1]
h Use the scales to calculate the following in µm: h i State the letters of two plant cells. [2]
i the height of the palisade cell ii State the letter of the cell with a surface
ii the width of the palisade cell adapted for the uptake of minerals. [1]
iii the width of the epithelial cell at its
widest point
iv the length of a single chloroplast
v the length of an animal cell nucleus. [S]
7 The diagram shows a single-celled organism 9 Use words from this list to complete the
called Chlamydomonas. This organism is able following paragraphs. The words may be used
to swim about in the small pools of water once, more than once or not at all.
where it lives. palisade cell, epidermis, tissues, excretory
system, specialised, cells, blood, kidney,
chloroplasts, leaf, red blood cell, division of
labour, xylem, phloem, nervous, systems,
endocrine, organ.
a Large numbers of __ that have the
same structure and function are grouped
together to form - -, for example - -·
Several separate tissues may be joined
together to form an __ which is a
complex structure capable of performing
a particular task with great efficiency. In
a In the table below, which set of numbers (A, B, the most highly developed organisms, these
C or D) correctly relates functions of cell parts complex structures may work together in
to the structures labelled in the diagram? - -, for example the __ in humans is
responsible for the removal of the waste
Function
products of metabolism. [6]
Protection Photosynthesis Movement Control of
against cell
h The structure of cells may be highly
bursting activities adapted to perform one function, i.e. the
A 2 4 1 3 cells may become - -· One excellent
B 1 3 2 4 example is the __ which is highly adapted
C 4 2 3
to carry oxygen in mammalian blood. If
the different cells, tissues and organs of a
D 2 4 3
multicellular organism perform different
[1] functions they are said to show - -· One
h State three structures in the Chlamydomonas consequence of this is the need for close
cell that would not be found in a sperm co-ordination between different organs -
cell. [3] this function is performed by the __ and
8 On the following diagram of a liver cell, identify: __ systems in mammals. [S]
a which structure carries out aerobic respiration c In plants, an example of a cell highly
h which structure controls the movement of specialised for photosynthesis is the __
salts into the cell which contains many - -· These cells are
c which structure would carry the genes located in the organ called the __ which
d which feature increases the surface area of also contains other tissues such as __
the cell which limits water loss and __ which
e which structure is a food store. [4] transports water and mineral ions to
the leaf. [S]
0
0
_____________,. ~ - - - A
29
.
CHARACTERISTICS AND CLASSIFICATION OF LIVING ORGANISMS
OBJECTIVES
■ To understand that the contents of a living cell must be
Partially permeable membranes
Not all particles can diffuse through cell surface
kept separate from its surroundings
membranes. Sometimes the particles are too big, or
■ To know that the cell surface membrane can act
they have the wrong electrical charge on them, or
as a barrier to some substances which might pass
the chemical composition of the membrane prevents
between a cell and its surroundings
them passing across. The diagram below shows a
■ To understand the principles of diffusion, osmosis, active partially permeable membrane - it is permeable
transport and phagocytosis to glucose and water but impermeable to protein.
On page 22, we saw that the cell cytoplasm is Diffusion and life processes
surrounded by a cell surface membrane. This acts Diffusion is the main process by which substances
as a boundary between the cell contents and its move over short distances in living organisms. Some
surroundings - it has very little strength, but it plays of the life processes that involve diffusion
a vital role in regulating the materials that pass in are shown in the diagram above right.
and out of the cell. Materials may pass in and out of
S Living organisms have certain adaptations to speed
cells by:
up diffusion:
■ diffusion
■ Diffusion distances are short - the membranes in
■ osmosis
the lungs, for example, are very thin so that oxygen
■ active transport
and carbon dioxide can diffuse between the blood
■ in special cases, phagocytosis.
and the lung air spaces.
Diffusion - 'mixing molecules' ■ Concentration gradients are maintained -
Molecules and ions in a liquid or a gas move glucose molecules that cross from the gut into the
continuously. The movement is quite random, and blood, for example, are quickly removed by the
the particles change direction as they bump into one circulating blood so that their concentration does
another. The particles collide more often when they not build up and equilibrium is not reached.
are close together (when they are concentrated) ■ Diffusion surfaces are large - the surface of the
and so they tend to diffuse, or spread out, until placenta, for example, is highly folded to increase
they are spaced evenly throughout the gas or liquid. the surface area for the diffusion of molecules
E The random movement of the particles is due to between a pregnant female and the developing
their own kinetic energy. When diffusion happens fetus in her uterus.
in living cells, the cells themselves do not have to
Key
expend any energy for it to take place.
(_ 0 0
0 0
0
0
If there is a region of high concentration and a
region of low concentration, we can say that there is
Protein
Glucose
0
0
0 0
0
0
A Many life processes depend on diffusion to move substances around. Diffusion has no 'energy cost'
to a living organism.
--
Trough 1 20
2 41
Acid 3 76
4 104
5 188
Agar cubes
10 600
a Copy and complete the table. Plot a graph of surface area to volume
ratio against time taken to tum orange. Plot time taken on the vertical
axis.
b What do the results suggest about the efficiency of diffusion in supplying
materials to the centre of an organism's body?
c Suggest methods which organisms might use to improve the supply
of materials by diffusion. Try to provide examples of these methods.
0 00 0 0 0 0
various substances, molecules can move from one to the other by
diffusion, if the membrane is permeable to these substances.
0 0 0 0 0 The diagram on the left shows two glucose solutions separated
0 0 0 00 0 by a partially permeable membrane - this membrane will allow
OooQ o oo the diffusion of water molecules but not glucose (the solute)
molecules. As a result, water can move from the right, where
0 o o o oO there is a high concentration of water molecules, to the left,
0
00 0 0Partially
0 0
permeable
where there is a lower concentration of water molecules, by the
process of diffusion. This diffusion of water is called osmosis,
__ membrane and will continue until a water equilibrium has been reached.
Key
S Because it is sometimes confusing to talk about water
Q =glucose O = water 'concentration', biologists use the term water potential instead.
A solution with many water molecules has a high water
potential, and a solution with few water molecules has a low
water potential. In the diagram, a water potential gradient
exists between the two solutions, and water molecules can flow
down this gradient from right to left.
Osmosis can be defined as:
■ the diffusion of water molecules
■ from a region of higher concentration of water molecules
Water flows down a to a region of lower concentration of water molecules
water potential gradient - osmosis ~ • down a water potential gradient
■ through a partially permeable membrane.
Cell surface
membrane
Cell in solution of lower water Cell in solution of equal water Cell in solution of higher water
potential than cell contents - potential - no net movement potential - water enters by
water leaves by osmosis. of water; cytoplasm just osmosis. The cytoplasm pushes
The cytoplasm pul ls away presses against cell wall. hard against the cell wall and
from the cell wal l and the cel l the cell becomes turgid (firm).
becomes flaccid ('floppy').
33
.
CHARACTERISTICS AND CLASSIFICATION OF LIVING ORGANISMS
Active transport requires energy uptake of ions by plant root hairs (page 88) and
to move materials the uptake of glucose by epithelial cells of the villi.
Molecules and ions can move from one place to To summarise - active transport:
another by diffusion, but only until an equilibrium ■ can move molecules against a concentration
has been reached. If no concentration gradient gradient but
exists between the two places, no diffusion can ■ requires energy and
occur-this means that if an equilibrium has been ■ involves protein carriers in membranes.
reached, useful particles cannot be absorbed by
diffusion. Active transport is a method by which Some cells use phagocytosis*
particles can cross membranes even against Some particles are too large to cross a
a concentration gradient. In active transport, membrane by diffusion or by active transport.
protein molecules in the cell surface membrane A few very specialised cells have developed
a method for taking up these particles - the
pick up and carry particles across the membrane.
These protein molecules are called carriers, and particles are literally engulfed by the cell surface
when they work they use energy supplied by the membrane flowing around them. This process of
phagocytosis is used by white blood cells, and is
cell. Active transport is explained in the diagram
below, and important examples of its use are the described on page 11 7.
S Particle recognised by
Carrier protein returns ◄ Active transport uses energy
-
carrier protein in membrane.
to collect more of the to move substances against a
same particle. - concentration gradient. The
protein carriers involved in active
transport are rather like
enzymes. They are able to
--
recognise particular molecules
Particle released into and select them from a mixture.
• •-
cell, even against a As a result active transport is
concentration gradient.
specific, and the cell can
'choose' which molecules it
absorbs from its surroundings.
,.....__ Respiration supplies
® 1 Copy and complete the following paragraphs. be moved using the process called - -, which
Animal cells contain - -, a semi-fluid solution of salts consumes _ _ and can move molecules _ _ a
and other molecules, and are surrounded by a - -· concentration gradient.
When in distilled water, the animal cells _ _ because The leaves of green plants obtain the gas - -,
the cell has a _ _ water potential than the which they require for the process of photosynthesis,
surrounding water. Plant cells do not have this by the process of - -· They also lose the gas oxygen,
problem because they are surrounded by a produced during _ , by the same process.
In the gut, soluble food substances such as _ _ 0 Make a table that compares diffusion with active
cross the gut lining into the capillaries by the process transport. Include one example of each process in
of - -, which is the movement of molecules down your table. Under what circumstances would an
a - -· When an equilibrium is reached between the organism use phagocytosis rather than diffusion or
gut contents and the blood, glucose may continue to active transport?
34
1 Using only the information in the following passage and the
figure below, answer questions i to v.
OBJECTIVES
combinations, by a reaction called condensation,
■ To understand that the structures of living things
which produces water (see opposite page).
depend on the molecules that make them up
■ To list the types of molecule found in living organisms In this way living organisms can take molecules
from their environment and rearrange them
into shapes that suit their own particular
Organic molecules requirements, as illustrated below.
Biological molecules are often called organic
molecules, because many of them were Hydrolysis: la rge molecules are
broken down to smaller ones by
discovered in living organisms. Chemists have the addition of water.
found that organic molecules all contain carbon
and hydrogen atoms (often along with other Starch in
elements). Carbon atoms bond strongly to other maize
repair of tissues.
Nutrition supplies living organisms with the
molecules that they need. There are four main
groups of organic chemicals used by living things:
Condensation: large molecules
■ carbohydrates
are built up from smaller ones
■ lipids by the removal of water.
■ proteins
A The carbohydrate starch in the maize is hydrolysed in
■ nucleic acids.
the rat's cells into subunits called glucose. These are then built
The diagram on the next page shows the
up into the carbohydrate glycogen by condensation reactions.
structures of these different groups of organic
molecules: note which elements they contain.
Basic biochemistry*
® 1 List the main groups of organic compounds found
Living organisms also contain inorganic molecules in living organisms. Suggest one important function
(such as water) and a number of ions. The study of for each group.
the organic and inorganic molecules that make up 2 Some molecules such as glucose and amino acids
are soluble, whereas others such as starch and fats
living organisms is called biochemistry. The sum
are insoluble. Why is this physical property
of all the chemical reactions in living organisms is
important in living organisms?
sometimes called metabolism.
0 Some scientists would say that nucleic acids are
Large organic molecules are usually made up of the most important molecules in living cells;
lots of similar smaller molecules called subunits. others might suggest that proteins are more
The subunits can be split apart by a reaction important; and some might say that life could
called hydrolysis, which uses water. They not continue without a supply of carbohydrates.
can be joined together again, perhaps in new Write a sentence in support of each of these
points of view.
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
0
example, glucose. Glucose is soluble molecules of fatty acid
so it is easily transported in blood with one molecule
and dissolves in the cytoplasm of glycerol.
of cells. Monosaccharides are
ll
the main source of energy for Glycerol Fatty acids
Hydrolysis
many cells.
s Proteins (page 62) Proteins are made up of long Nucleic acids (page 208)
chains of subunits called amino
In DNA. these chains are coiled
acids, joined together in
around one another to form a
particular sequences which are
double hellix. The sequence
coded for by genes. The 20
of bases forms a code which
different amino acids can be
carries the genetic information.
joined together in a vast
This code is passed from one
number of different orders, and
generation to the next and
some proteins are thousands of
instructs a cell or an organism to
amino acids long. The sequence
carry out a particular task.
of amino acids determines the
shape of the protein molecule -
some are long and thin (such as
So
few drops: strong vitamin C solution
many drops: weak vitamin C solution
To test for protein, To test for starch, a few drops To test for glucose (a reducing
a few drops of Biuret reagent of iodine solution are added to sugar), 2 cm 3 of Benedict's
are added to 2 cm3 of the 2 cm 3 of the unknown solution, reagent are added to 2 cm 3 of
unknown solution, and the and the mixture is gently shaken. the unknown solution, and the
mixture is gently shaken. A deep blue-black colour is a mixture is heated in a boiling
A mauve/purple colour is a positive result (starch is present). water bath for 2- 3 minutes. An
positive result (protein orange/brick-red colour is a
is present). positive result (glucose is present).
39
.
CHARACTERISTICS AND CLASSIFICATION OF LIVING ORGANISMS
40
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
the enzyme molecules vibrate so much that they become denatured - they
lose their three-dimensional shape and can no longer bind to their substrate.
Because of this, high temperatures reduce enzyme activity. Each enzyme
has an optimum temperature, which is a balance between these two effects, as
shown in the graph below. Most human enzymes have an optimum temperature
around 3 7°C, whilst for most plants the optimum is rather lower at around 25°C.
Denaturation is usually irreversible, and living cells make great efforts to keep the
conditions suitable for their enzymes to work.
Temperature I ·c
pH
pH also affects enzyme activity.
(s) Changing the acid or base conditions around an enzyme molecule affects its three-
'y' dimensional shape and can denature the enzyme.
Each enzyme has its own optimum pH, as shown in the graph below, which
depends on the environment in which the enzyme is working - pepsin is an enzyme
that works in the stomach, and has an optimum pH around pH 2.0 (very acidic),
whereas amylase works in the mouth and small intestine and has an optimum pH
around 7.5 (slightly basic).
pH extremes may
denature the enzyme/
pH
Molecules
of substrate
Active site
/ E-•
I
Substrate molecules
The enzyme fit exactly into the C
molecule is 0
active site of the ·t3
now free to
1]tJ ft!
...
-...
enzyme to form an QI
bind with more enzyme-substrate 0
molecules of complex. The active >-
c,
substrate. site brings the QI
C
Each enzyme substrate molecules w
molecule may closer together.
be used many Product Time
thousands i:::;- ✓ The substrates now
.&. The enzyme lowers the energy
of times. ·~ react to form a
molecule of product,
needed for the reaction, and the
which leaves the reaction is then much more likely to
active site. take place.
® 1 Copy and complete the following paragraph about 0 Enzyme action is explained by the lock and key
enzymes. hypothesis (see box above). The example shows an
Enzymes are __ which speed up the biochemical __ enzyme that catalyses a condensation reaction - two
in living organisms. The enzymes themselves are not small molecules are joined together to make a larger
changed in these reactions, that is they are biological one. Redraw the diagram to show the action of an
enzyme catalysing a hydrolysis reaction, and give
Enzymes are __ - each one controls only one type of an example of such an enzyme.
reaction . They are _ by high temperatures and by
extremes of pH.
42
Questions on enzymes and
biological molecules
1 The diagram below shows a protein molecule. 3 a The diagram below shows an enzyme-
catalysed reaction.
~ A
a Name the subunit molecules that are
assembled into the protein. [1]
h Name two proteins found in the
human body. [2]
c State two places in the human body
where many proteins are made. [2]
d Some seeds are rich in proteins. Describe
the chemical test that you would use to
determine whether different types of seed
are rich in proteins. Include the practical
details of the test in your answer. [4]
2 A student used the DCPIP test to find out how
much vitamin C is present in different fruit i State the names of A, B and C. [3]
juices. The concentration of the DCPIP solution
ii Use the diagram to describe what
was 10 g per dm3 • The student followed these
happens when an enzyme catalyses a
instructions:
reaction. [3]
1 Put 2 cm3 of DCPIP solution into a test tube.
iii Explain why the model is known as
2 Use a graduated pipette or burette to add
'lock and key'. [2]
a 10 g per dm3 vitamin C solution drop by
h Explain the following statements:
drop to the DCPIP solution. Shake the tube
i Amylase digests starch, but proteases
gently after adding each drop. Continue to
do not. [1]
add the vitamin C solution until the colour
ii Human enzymes catalyse reactions
of the DCPIP solution disappears.
at 37°C, but not at 73°C. [2]
3 Record the volume of vitamin C solution
c The table shows the relative activity of a
that was added.
human enzyme in solutions of different pH
4 Repeat the procedure two more times and
kept at 35°C.
calculate a mean volume.
5 Repeat steps 1 to 4 with the juices to be tested. pH Relative activity
The results are shown in the table below. 3 4
1 2 3 mean
7 31
4 a The bar chart below shows the percentage of each of the main
elements in the human body.
Convert this data into:
i a table
ii a pie chart.
Which do you think is the better way of showing the data?
Explain why.
b These elements are mostly present in the body as part of
compounds.
The proportions of the main groups of compounds in a human
body are shown in the table.
i Which is the most abundant compound?
ii Which compound contains most of the nitrogen in the body?
iii Which compound contains most of the oxygen?
iv Which compound contains most of the carbon?
v The total of these compounds does not add up to 100%.
Suggest another organic compound that forms a proportion
of the remainder.
vi Try to find out which structure(s) in the body contain most
of the calcium.
70
60
50
CII
c:n
...
Ill
C
40
...,.,
CII
30
:!.
20
10
0
Oxygen Carbon Hydrogen Nitrogen Calcium Phosphorus Iron/
others
44
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
Boiled
Saliva Saliva cooled Water
saliva
1% 1% 1% 1%
starch starch starch starch
The tubes were shaken. They were immediately tested for starch
by adding one drop of iodine solution to one drop of the mixture
in a specimen tube. The test was repeated at intervals.
0 minutes
A B C D
10 minutes
y
No change Turned blue-black
A B C D
20 minutes
I
No change Turned blue-black
45
.
CHARACTERISTICS AND CLASSIFICATION OF LIVING ORGANISMS
SUN
Some of the glucose produ ced is stored in the plant cells as starch .
The experiment below shows h ow a starch test can be u sed to
demonstrate the conditions needed for photosynth esis.
To demonstrate t hat
some factor is necessary
fo r the production of Ethanol
st arch, the plant must
have no starch t o begin Boiling water
w it h. The plant is placed in Leaf - + -.._~ Warm water
a dark cupboard or box
fo r 48 hours. It uses any
st arch t hat is already in its
(a) Leaf is boiled in water for about 2 minutes. (b) Leaf is warmed in ethanol until leaf
leaves and is now
Purpose: to break down cell walls and to stop is colourless. Purpose: to extract the
destarched.
the action of enzymes within the leaf. Also chlorophyll, which would mask
allows easier penetration by ethanol. observations later. (Chlorophyll dissolves
in ethanol but not in water.)
C'?
(c) Leaf is dipped into warm water (briefly). (d) Leaf is placed on white tile and iodine
Purpose: to soften the now brittle leaf, and solution added. Purpose: iodine shows
allow penetration by iodine solution. the presence (blue-black) or absence
(orange-brown) of starch; colours are
shown against the white tile.
A C
B Airtight
seal around
Black A B C
leaf stalk
paper
Q
cl ipped
0 t
onto both
Soda lime (I)
sides of
leaf
Hydrogen carbonate
solution (II)
®
These questions are about the diagram above. necessary for starch formation by photosynthesis.
1 Before testing for starch, the leaf is warmed in ethanol. 0 The students' teacher asked for some further tests to be
The ethanol turns green. Why is this? completed before accepting their results as valid.
2 A group of students wanted to investigate the a How could the students show that there was no
conditions needed for photosynthesis. They set up the starch in the leaves at the start of the experiment?
three experiments shown as A, Band C. Each of the b The teacher suggested that the black paper attached
plants was given the same light conditions. to the leaf in experiment A prevented the leaf from
a What does the result of experiment A suggest? absorbing gases, and that was why no starch had
b Soda lime removes carbon dioxide from the been produced in the covered area.
atmosphere, and hydrogencarbonate slowly releases How could the students disprove this theory?
it. What do the results of experiment B suggest about 0 What additional experiment could be set up to show
carbon dioxide and starch formation? that the formation of starch by photosynthesis depends
c What is the purpose of experiment C? on the activity of enzymes? (There is a clue given in one
d From experiments A, B and C, list the factors part of the diagram above.)
47
.
CHARACTERISTICS AND CLASSIFICATIO N OF LIVING ORGANISMS
Measuring photosynthesis
The most straightforward way of showing whether or not photosynthesis
To understand a quantitative has occurred is to test for the presence of starch. Starch is a product of
method of investigating photosynthesis and the blue-black colour of the iodine test is a simple
photosynthesis method for detecting it. Unfortunately, this is an 'all-or-nothing' test, that
■ To perform an exercise in is, the colour is just as dark with a small amount of starch as it is with
experimental design a large amount. The iodine test is said to be qualitative - it only shows
whether or not starch is present. To find out how quickly photosynthesis
is going on, we need to use a quantitative test.
The basic equation for photosynthesis is:
The simplest apparatus for measuring oxygen release is Stopwatch used to count
shown in the next box. This method depends on counting the number of bubbles
in a fixed time.
the number of oxygen bubbles given off in a fixed length
oftime. 0
0
•
0
Apparatus that can be used to measure the volume of •
oxygen released in a fixed length of time is shown on the 0
0
opposite page. When looking at this, remind yourself of Oo
0
the principles of experimental technique. Light source 0
0
o.
0
•
0
~
• Test tube
"
Pondweed
Plasticine support j
Funnel
lifts fun nel off
bottom of beaker.
; \ Beaker
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
®
1 What important assumption about the bubbles is being Samantha and Jane wanted to investigate whether the
made, when using the method shown on the page wavelength of the light would affect photosynthesis,
opposite, to measure the rate of photosynthesis? and decided that they could use the same apparatus.
0 Using the apparatus above, Samantha and Jane d What is the input variable in this investigation? How
obtained the results shown in the table. could the two students change this variable?
a Plot this information in the form of a graph. e What are the fixed variables in this investigation?
f The students decided to repeat their experiment,
Light intensity / Volume of oxygen and then to pool their results with the results of
arbitrary units released / mm3 per minute other students in the same class. Why was this
1 7 pooling of results important?
2 14 g The teacher said that if the students were going to
3 21 pool their results then they must remove the plants
from the apparatus and weigh them. Why should
4 28
they do this?
5 34
h State the input, outcome and fixed variables in an
6 39 investigation into the effect of temperature on the
7 42 rate of photosynthesis.
8 44 3 This question is about the box 'Tracing photosynthesis'
9 45 on the opposite page.
a What important assumption is being made when
10 45
using the rate of uptake of 14CO2 as a measure of
b At what light intensity did the plant produce the rate of photosynthesis?
25 mm 3 of oxygen per minute? b Why is it important that radioactively labelled
c What levels of light intensity had the greatest effect carbon dioxide, 14 CO2, is treated by leaf cells in
on the rate of photosynthesis? How could this exactly the same way as 'normal' carbon dioxide?
information be useful to a grower of greenhouse c Which process might release 14 (02 from the plant?
tomatoes?
49
.
CHARACTERISTICS AND CLASSIFICATION OF LIVING ORGANISMS
Waxy cuticle - reduces water loss. It is thicker on the upper Upper epidermis - a complete covering which is usually one cell thick.
surface because this surface is usually more exposed to the It is transparent to allow the free passage of light, and has the important
warming rays of sunlight. function of preventing the entry of disease-causing organisms such as
bacteria and f ungi.
Vein - the transport system in and out of the leaf. The xylem
- -- - - vessels deliver water and mineral salts, and the phloem sieve
tubes carry away the organic products of photosynthesis,
such as glucose.
Stomata - (singular: stoma) these minute pores When a plant has plenty of water, the g uard cells become turgid. The cell wall on
allow the entry of carbon dioxide and the exit the inner surface is very thick, so it cannot stretch as much as the outer surface. So
of oxygen. They are mainly present in t he as the guard cells swell up, they curve away from each other, opening the stoma.
lower epidermis. This surface is less exposed to
Closed Open
the Sun's radiation so that evaporation of
water is kept to a minimum. The stomata
can be closed when no carbon dioxide
intake is needed (in the dark, for example). Turgid --+,,-
Thick
g uard cell
~ ~ + - - cell wall
When a plant is short of water,
the guard cells become flaccid, Stoma ---+1,.:..=:e.....:....--1
closed Thin
closing the stoma.
.,...___ cell wall
L
50 .A Leaf structure is a compromise between maximising photosynthesis and minimising water loss
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
This diagram shows how leaf, palisade cell and chloroplast are adapted for
photosynthesis
Leaf blade has a large surface to
trap light and is thin so that light
Cells of the upper Palisade cells are packed together and f il led
can penetrate.
epidermis do not with chloroplasts. Best site for photosynthesis
Interior of leaf have chloroplasts. because light penetrates, carbon dioxide and
magnified x300 Light passes easily water are delivered and chlorophyll is present.
with a light through them.
Chloroplasts can move
within the cell to make
best use of available light.
Waxy cuticle is
transparent.
~;:::-.-
membrane are
CO 2 from freely permeable
the air to CO 2 and water.
Xylem ...:__---rf
(carries water
Vascular and minerals) Thin layer of
bundle Phloem ------ water on cell
(carries away sucrose, surface can
lucose) dissolve CO 2 .
~ Single palisade
cell magnified
x800 with
Spongy cells have few
a lig ht
chloroplasts. Large
spaces between them
Stomata are pores allow easy diffusion of
that allow CO 2 to water and CO 2 through
diffuse into the leaf. leaf to palisade cells.
s
2 Light energy reaches the •• _ 4 Oxygen is released
as a waste product.
chlorophyll molecules. ◄ Chloroplasts are the
f) site of photosynthesis
- Ca rbon dioxide
of photosynthesis is
catalysed by enzymes. N Oxygen
(X) Hydrogen
® 1 Work out the magnification of the single chloroplast. Show how you reached your answer.
0 Glucose
51
.
CHARACTERISTICS AND CLASSIFICATION OF LIVING ORGANISMS
s 2s·c
J::
u
0
0
0 ~D. D./o D
~=
Ill
oO 0 0 0 0 0
;: .E
o E 1s·c 0 0 0
0
0
J::
• Ill
.. 0
0 0 0 D
0
C'I c.
Gi ,:,
C"'
• Ill
0 0 o/D. D.~ 0 0
0 ,,i
•-
t: -Ill
,,i ~
~ C
-0 Ill
3 If the bottleneck is widened, in this case by raising the
C'I
Ill >, temperature, more substrate molecules can be converted
~ ~ to product.
1:11:
I
Concentration of carbon dioxide
0 0 0
0 D.
0 00 D. 0 □
G -Product 0 0
0 0 o o o 0 0
Substrate 0 00
0 □
0 0
0 ~D. D.~ D
■ During any 24-hour period, light will be the warm up the air, for example. However, in an
limiting factor from dusk to dawn. enclosed environment, such as a greenhouse,
■ During a British winter, plants may not it is possible to control the factors affecting
photosynthesise on a bright, sunny day photosynthesis and so get the maximum yield
because temperature is the limiting factor. from crops. This requires an understanding
of the principle of limiting factors - it is no
The availability of water is rarely a limiting
good simply increasing the light availability
factor for photosynthesis, because there are so
by having lights on in dull weather
many other physiological processes in plants that
without making sure that carbon dioxide
depend on water that these processes will usually
concentration and temperature are adequate,
halt in a water shortage before photosynthesis
for example. A greenhouse grower will also
does.
try to use strains of plants selected for their
Controlling the limiting factors high yield (see page 54), control any potential
In an open field, there is very little that farmers pests and will probably use automatic
can do to speed up photosynthesis - they systems to control the factors that might limit
cannot change the degree of cloud cover or the crop yield.
® 1 List the three most important factors that control 4 What is a limiting factor? Which limiting factor is
the rate of photosynthesis. most likely to affect photosynthesis:
0 The burning of fossil fuels can both help and a on a cloudy, spring day
hinder photosynthesis. Explain this statement. b on a bright, sunny day in winter
3 Which ion deficiency is most likely to affect c in the middle of a crop field on a sunny, warm
photosynthesis? Explain why. July day?
53
.
CHARACTERISTICS AND CLASSIFICATION OF LIVING ORGANISMS
® 1 The table below shows the rate of photosynthesis of geranium plants under eight different sets of conditions, A to H.
s
Light intensity / Carbon dioxide Temperature / °C Rate of photosynthesis /
arbitrary units concentration / % arbitrary units
A 4 0.03 20 60
B 8 0.03 20 60
C 4 0.15 20 120
D 8 0.15 20 180
E 4 0.03 30 60
F 8 0.03 30 60
G 4 0.15 30 170
H 8 0.15 30 250
a Calculate the percentage increase in the crop yield of lettuce in the enriched atmosphere. Show your working.
b Three possible ways of increasing the carbon dioxide concentration in the greenhouse atmosphere are:
■ using paraffin heaters in the greenhouse (combustion releases carbon dioxide and water)
■ keeping small animals, such as rabbits, in the greenhouse
■ releasing carbon dioxide from gas cylinders.
Suggest and explain the best method for increasing the crop yield.
3 The graph below shows the rate of photosynthesis.
8
~ ...
7
6
--
::I~
c.,:;
~ ai 5
J!! Q.
CII N
:5! 4 5
~o
·- in
"Cl
C
...
CII
3
0 Q.
.Q Cl
:; E
V 2
40 50
55
.
CHARACTERISTICS AND CLASSIFICATION OF LIVING ORGANISMS
• •
decreases, the indicator solution
Even source turns purple.
of light
pH falls
Processes going on in living plant cells (more acidic)
56
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
A. Plants produce all their food molecules from the products of photosynthesis by metabolic reactions
r Carbon dioxide
in the atmosphere
Simple, inorganic
Addition Removal
Carried in by - - - - , - - -
- - - Uptake by plants to
flooding rivers.
build food molecules.
Decomposition of animal
and plant remains In cultivated soils, removal
(pages 250, 252). by these two processes is
Minerals in the soil
so great that minerals must
be added as fertil isers.
Breakdownof bed rock by - - --,-
weathering, plant roots Leac~ing as ions dissolve
and burrowing animals. in rainwater running
through the soil.
.._ Minerals are added to the soil and also removed by natural processes
58
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
The apparatus shown on the right can be used to investigate the effects Plant - a cereal such as grass
is usually chosen because growth
of mineral deficiencies on plant growth. Cerea l plants of equal age and is rapid.
size are grown in a series of culture solutions. One of the solutions
contains all known mineral nutrients in the correct proportions; each of
the others is missing a single minera l. All the vessels are placed in
identica l condit ions of temperature and light intensity, and the plants
-- Cotton wool
support for plant.
are allowed to grow for equal lengths of t ime.
1 Why is the vessel surrounded by black paper?
2 The bubbled air supply provides oxygen to the roots. Why might this
be important in minera l uptake?
( f\ Glass vessel w ith
black paper cover.
59
Questions on photosynthesis and
plant nutrition
1 What is the green pigment which absorbs light 4 The diagram below shows a simplified diagram
energy for photosynthesis called? of a section through the green part of a leaf.
A Haemoglobin
B Chlorophyll
C Keratin
D Chloroplast [ 1]
2 Starch produced during photosynthesis
can be detected by which solution?
A Biuret solution
B Benedict's solution
C Iodine solution
D DCPIP [1]
3 A plant with variegated (green and white) leaves
Spongy layer
was destarched. Part of one leaf was covered
on both sides with black paper as shown in
the diagram below. The plant was left in bright
light for 8 hours. The leaf was then detached
and tested for the presence of starch.
IOOpm
. 0
60
0
t
j~
i '
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
61
.
CHARACTERISTICS AND CLASSIFICATION OF LIVING ORGANISMS
To understand why organisms require food (see page 38). A balanced diet should contain the
■ To list the constituents of an ideal diet correct proportions of carbohydrates, lipids,
■ To know the functions of each component proteins, vitamins and minerals, water and
of an ideal diet dietary fibre. We shall look at each in turn.
A balanced diet
The total of the molecules or nutrients that
we need is called the diet. A balanced diet
®1 Give three reasons why living organ isms need food.
provides all the nutrients, in the correct amounts, 2 Write one sentence to explain the difference
needed to carry out the life processes. If the between autotrophic and heterotrophic nutrition.
diet does not provide all the nutrients in the 3 What is a balanced diet?
correct proportions, a person may suffer from 4 List the main energy foods for humans.
malnutrition (see page 68, for example). 5 State four functions of proteins, using particular
examples to illustrate your answer.
Food can be analysed to find out what chemicals
it contains using quite simple chemical techniques.
62
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
Carbohydrates
Rice, potatoes, wheat (e.g. pasta) and other A source of energy. Glucose is oxidised in Carbohydrates are digested in the mouth and
cereals provide starch. Food sweetenings, respiration (see page 122) to release small intestine and absorbed as glucose.
such as those in desserts, sweets and soft energy for active transport, cell division, Refined sugars are absorbed very rapidly,
drinks, and preservatives provide refined muscle contraction and the manufacture of giving a sudden boost of 'energy source'.
sugars, such as sucrose (cane sugar) large biological molecules. Excess Starch is digested and absorbed more slowly,
and glucose. carbohydrate can be stored as glycogen giving a steady supply of energy: starches are
(see page 148) and as fat. called slow-release carbohydrates.
Lipids
Meat and animal foods (eggs, milk, cheese) Fats and oils are an important source of Fats and oils are digested in the small
are rich in saturated fats and cholesterol. energy (see page 62). They are especially intestine and absorbed as fatty acids and
Plant sources such as sunflower seeds and valuable as an energy store because they glycerol. Some lipids contain saturated
peanuts are rich in unsaturated fats. are insoluble in water. They also provide fatty acids and others contain unsaturated
insulation - electrical insulation around fatty acids (with at least one carbon-carbon
nerve cells (see page 156) and thermal double bond). The body can store unlimited
insulation beneath the skin (page 146)- and amounts of fat, contributing to obesity (see
form part of cell membranes. Steroid page 68). The incorrect balance of saturated
hormones, including sex hormones, are and unsaturated fatty acids, or an excess of
made from cholesterol. cholesterol, can cause diseases of the
circulation (see page 106).
Proteins
Meat, fish, eggs from animals, and legumes Many functions, including Digested in the stomach and small intestine,
(peas and beans) and pulses from plants. One ■ enzymes (catalysts) (page 40) and absorbed as amino acids. Twenty different
of the best sources of protein is the soya bean. ■ transport molecules, such as amino acids are needed to make up all of the
This contains very little fat (unlike most animal haemoglobin (page 96) different proteins in the human body. Some of
sources) and so is suitable for people with ■ structural materials, as in muscles these must be supplied in the diet as the body
health problems caused by fat (see page 106). (page 124) cannot make them - these are the essential
Soya beans can be flavoured and textured to ■ hormones, such as insulin (page 148) amino acids. Proteins from animal sources
make them taste and feel like meat - this ■ in defence against disease, such as usually contain all 20 amino acids, but plant
textured vegetable protein is used as antibodies (page 118) proteins often lack one or two of the essential
'artificial' meat. Mycoprotein is also a amino acids. Deficiency of protein causes poor
low-fat substitute for meat derived from fungi. growth - in extreme cases it may cause
marasmus or kwashiorkor (see page 69).
Vitamins
Water-soluble Food source Symptoms of deficiency Comments
C (ascorbic acid) Cherries, citrus fruits e.g. limes, Scurvy - production of collagen Vitamin C also seems to protect cells
lemons, oranges, and fresh green fibres in the body is affected. from ageing.
leafy vegetables
Fat-soluble Food source Symptoms of deficiency Comments
D (calciferol) Liver, dairy products, eggs, Rickets - bones are soft and may Can be made by the body, just under
fish liver oil bend, because vitamin D is needed the skin, but only if there is plenty of
for the absorption of calcium. sunlight.
Minerals
Food source Symptoms of deficiency Comments
Iron Red meat, liver, some leafy Anaemia - iron is needed to Iron is added to foods when metal
vegetables, e.g. spinach produce haemoglobin for red utensils are used in cooking - the
blood cells. A shortage causes amount of iron in a piece of beef is
weakness as oxygen needed for doubled when the meat is minced in
respiration cannot be transported an iron mincer ready for making
efficiently. burgers!
Calcium Milk, cheese and fish Several problems Calcium shortage causes rickets,
■ weak bones and teeth the same deficiency disease caused
■ poor clotting of blood by insufficient vitamin D.
■ uncontrolled muscle
contractions ('spasms').
Water
Water forms about 70% of the human body. Two-thirds of
this water is in the cytoplasm of cells, and the other third is in
tissue fluid and blood plasma. Humans lose about 1.5 litres of
water each day, in urine, faeces, exhaled air and sweat - this
must be replaced. It is obtained in three main ways:
■ as a drink
■ in food, especially salad foods such as tomatoes and lettuce
■ from metabolic processes (look at the equation for aerobic
respiration on page 123 - water is one of the products).
Key
®
1 Table 1 shows the composition and energy content of four common foods.
A Table 1
a Which food would be best to prevent rickets? Explain your answer.
b Which food would be best for a young person training for cross-country running? Explain your answer.
c Which food would be most needed by a menstruating woman? Explain your answer.
d Which food would be the most useful to a body-builder? Explain your answer.
e Which food would be most dangerous for a person with heart disease? Explain your answer.
65
.
CHARACTERISTICS AND CLASSIFICATION OF LIVING ORGANISMS
To suction pump*
To know that food has an energy value Thermometer
■ To know how to calculate the energy value of different
foods
■ To understand that different people have different
demands for energy
® 1 Table 1 shows the daily energy needs of different Use the following data and the formula to work out the
people. Table 2 shows the energy content of four foods. number of joules released from 1 gram of food which
a What is the daily energy need for an active caused the rise in temperature of the water.
8-year-old boy? Mass of water= 20 g
b How many grams of Food 3 would meet the energy Temperature rise = 18°C
needs of a male office worker? Mass of food = 2 g
c How much more energy does a labourer need than
a male office worker each day? Show your working. Person Occupation Daily energy
d From the foods given in Table 2, which ONE need I kJ
would be the best for the labourer to eat? Give a
Active girl aged 8 years Schoolgirl 8 000
reason for your choice.
ii If the labourer ate only the food you have Active boy aged 8 years Schoolboy 8 400
suggested in your answer to i, what is the least Woman ____ Office worker 9 500
amount he should eat to meet his daily energy
Man Office worker 10 500
need? Show your working.
e The heat energy in foods can be measured Active girl aged 15 years School girl 11 800
experimentally by burning food under a known mass Active boy aged 15 years School boy 14 700
of water. The temperature rise of the water is
Man Labourer 18 900
recorded. The number of joules received by the water
from 1 gram of food can be calculated using the
.A. Table 1
following formula:
Heat gained by water from Y grams of food
mass of water x temperature rise x 4.2 J Food 1 2 3 4
= y perg
Energy content/ kJ per 100 g 3 800 130 1050 400
.A. Table 2
.
CHARACTERISTICS AND CLASSIFICATION OF LIVING ORGANISMS
68
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
The energy balance diagram shows that to lose The absence of protein
means that muscle
body mass, it is necessary to reduce energy intake
development is very slow,
below energy use. This can be done in two ways: and the limbs have a stick-
■ by eating less 'high-energy' food, which will like appearance. The swollen
reduce the energy intake abdomen is caused largely by
water from the blood plasma
■ by taking more exercise, which will increase
remaining behind in the
the energy use. body tissues. The liver is also
swollen because it is working
The best approach is to combine both methods,
hard to make the proteins
controlling the diet and also taking more exercise.
needed by the body from an
Many people who rely on diet alone have great inadequate dietary supply.
difficulty in controlling their body mass.
® 1 True or false?
a A person suffering from malnutrition is has too little protein in their diet.
b Arthritis is more common in obese people because their diet contains too much fat. 69
.
CHARACTERISTICS AND CLASSIFICATION OF LIVING ORGANISMS
OBJECTIVES
■ To understand that malnutrition might not be the same A class of students used the apparatus shown here to
as undernutrition investigate the energy content of a peanut.
■ To name and explain some examples of malnutrition in They first recorded the temperature of the water (T1)
the developed world and weighed the nut. The nut was held in a Bunsen
burner flame until it caught fire, and then placed
under the boiling tube.
Malnutrition in the developed world The students recorded the maximum temperature the
As well as the problem of obesity, caused by water reached (T2), and then repeated the
experiment twice more. A typical set of results from
taking in more energy than is needed for the
one pair of students is shown in the table in 01
body's metabolism and activity, there are other opposite.
problems caused by an unbalanced diet for many
people in developed countries. These problems,
and the 'unbalanced diet' that causes them, are Boiling tube
Tooth decay
A diet with a high content of
acidic, sugary foods can cause
damage to tooth enamel and
dentine (see page 75).
®
1 a Copy and complete the table of results.
b Add a further column and include the energy value of the peanut in kJ per g.
c Calculate the mean energy value of the peanut as found by these students. Why is the mean value more valid
than any single value that they obtained?
d Can you suggest any improvements to the apparatus so that the students' value might be closer to the
'professional' one (24.5 kJ per g)? Redraw the apparatus showing your suggestions.
e What features of the method helped to improve the validity of the results? How could the students have treated
the results differently to improve their validity further?
TI
1
°C TI
2
°C Volume of Energy transferred Mass of nut / g Energy value /
water / cm3 to water / kcal kcal per g
22 78 0.45
22 74 0.52
21 75 0.47
·-
Ill
,:,
a State which country has the largest proportion of people ...
CU 300
c.
with colon cancer.
-en
France
of fibre:
wholemeal bread cheese chocolate
::II
0
E
<C
150
•• Germany
• UK
apples eggs pizza 100
•USA
so -------,.--------~
0 5 10 15 20 25 30
Number of people per 100 000
of population with colon cancer
71
.
CHARACTERISTICS AND CLASSIFICATION OF LIVING ORGANISMS
73
.
CHARACTERISTICS AND CLASSIFICATION OF LIVING ORGANISMS
To understand the part played by teeth and the tongue The teeth in the skull
in preparing food for the alimentary canal
.,,
Decayed part of tooth
is drilled out by a dentist . ®0 How do we know that a tooth is a living structure?
2 Imagine yourself on a sailing ship several hundred years ago. Explain, simply,
why the sailors were losing their teeth.
3 a What is dental caries?
b How does it begin?
c Suggest two ways in which caries can be prevented or reduced.
amylase
starch > maltose Circular Circular Gut wall
muscles muscles
relax contract
~ ater
• Peristalsis is a wave of muscular contraction that moves
food along the gut. Mucus lubricates the bolus, helping it to
move along.
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
I
hydrochloric O 0
0
acid
)
0 0 0
0 0
0 0 0 Nasal passage
I
+ water
00 0 Hard palate
0 0
0 0 0 Mouth cavity
0 0
Food - --
Protein Amino acids Tongue
The pH in the stomach is too low (too acidic) Epiglottis
Oesophagus---- --
for the action of amylase, so the digestion of
Trachea - - - -- -
carbohydrate comes to a halt whilst the food is in
the stomach. The churning action of the stomach
muscles mixes the food into a creamy liquid
called chyme. Once the food is sufficiently liquid,
it squeezes past a ring of muscle at the foot of the
stomach, the pyloric sphincter, and enters the
duodenum, the first part of the small intestine.
er-->
Bile salts
in bile
Region of gut Digestive juice Enzymes Substrate Product(s) Other substances Function of
in juice other substances
Mouth Saliva from Salivary amylase Starch Maltose Hydrogencarbonate Alkaline (pH 7.5)
salivary glands environment
for amylase
Stomach Gastric juice from Pepsin (protease) Proteins Amino acids Hydrochloric acid Acidic (pH 2)
glands in wall of environment for
stomach pepsin; kills bacteria
Small intestine Pancreatic juice Pancreatic amylase Starch Maltose Hydrogen carbonate Neutralises chyme:
(duodenum) from pancreas Trypsin (a protease) Protein Amino acids alkaline environment
Lipase Emulsified fats Fatty acids for enzymes
and glycerol
Bile from liver None Bile salts Emulsifies fats -
(stored in gall converts globules
bladder) to smaller droplets
Hydrogen carbonate Neutralises chyme
Small intestine Intestinal juice Maltase on the Maltose Glucose
(i leum) from cells on vi lli surface membrane
of the epithelium
lining the sma ll
intestine
A The human digestive juices and their actions: note how starch and proteins are broken down in several stages catalysed by
different enzymes
® 1 In 1822, Alexis St Martin, a Canadian fur trapper, was controlled conditions. A similar piece of beef was
wounded in his left side by a shotgun blast. Luckily the suspended on a string into the man's stomach.'
accident occurred close to an army fort where one of the Suggest one condition around the vial that
surgeons, William Beaumont, was able to treat St Martin. Beaumont would have kept constant.
The wound healed very slowly, and left a small hole in the ii What control experiment should Beaumont have
side of the young man. Beaumont realised that this gave performed?
him a unique opportunity to study what was happening in 111 Why did Beaumont use 'boiled, salted beef'?
his patient's stomach. c After two hours, Beaumont recorded the following
results: 'Beef in vial - the cellular texture seemed to be
entirely destroyed, leaving the muscular fibres loose
and unconnected, floating about in fine, small shreds,
very tender and soft. Beef in stomach - I drew out the
string, but the meat was all completely digested and
gone.'
Use your knowledge of digestion to explain the
difference between the changes in the vial and those in
the stomach.
0
2 The liver produces a liquid which is added directly to the
C
partly digested food in the small intestine.
D
a Name the liquid.
A b Describe how it helps digestion.
3 Describe, in the correct sequence, how the protein and
a Which letter on the outline above represents starch in a ham sandwich are broken down
the most likely position of the hole? ready for absorption.
b Beaumont described one of his investigations as 4 Digestive juices contain enzymes, water and some other
follows: 'Juice was extracted from the stomach and substances. Name two of these other substances. State
placed in a small vial. A solid piece of boiled,
which digestive juice contains them, and state what
recently salted beef weighing three drachms function they perform.
was added. The vial was corked and kept under
79
.
CHARACTERISTICS AND CLASSIFICATION OF LIVING ORGANISMS
Section of ileum ----- Lacteal - transports fatty acids and glycerol (the
products of fat breakdown by the enzyme lipase).
Circular _ _.,,__
muscle
layer
~:::==-----:-:-:~=-~===----1
r-- Gland - lined with cells which produce
digestive enzymes including maltase.
♦
ammonia + sugar acid
carbon
dioxide
~ energy
via
respiration
urea + water
•
•
•
♦
to kidney for removal
■ removal of old red blood cells from the circulation and storage of the iron they
contained
■ breakdown of alcohol and other toxins, called detoxification.
A combination of transamination and deamination makes sure that there is always a
'pool' of amino acids available for use by the cells of the body.
As a result of these and other activities, the liver provides ideal concentrations of
food molecules for the working of the body tissues. Each type of tissue uses food
molecules for different purposes - for example, muscle cells manufacture muscle
protein, bone cells take up calcium and phosphate to make bone, and all cells use
glucose to release energy by respiration.
81
7.9 Absorption and assimilation make food available
The processes of moving food molecules into the cells where they are
used is called assimilation.
@
1 In what way is the blood supply to the liver unusual?
2 Name two substances stored in the liver, and two that are converted to
different substances.
3 How is the structure of the villus is adapted to its function.
4 What are goblet cells? Where else do you think they might be found apart
from in the gut?
0 Some microorganisms infect the gut lining so that water cannot be
absorbed. What effect(s) might this have on the infected person?
82
Questions on human nutrition
and health
0 The diagram shows a group of villi from the iv Describe how this juice plays a part
alimentary canal. in the digestion of fat. [3]
h Explain what is meant by the term
A V1ll1
assimilation. Use an example to help
your explanation. [2]
3 John and Paul were eating their school lunch.
Later, they decided to look up the nutritional
value of some of the foods in a book. The book
had a table showing what 100 g of each food
contains.
a Use Table 1 below and your biological
O Gland (produces
knowledge to answer the following
nzymes) questions.
i Which food shown in the table would
be best for preventing scurvy? [1]
ii John ate a sandwich containing 100 g
Circular mu~clcs
bread, 50 g of cheese and 10 g of butter.
How much energy did he take in?
a Identify the parts labelled X, Y and Z. [3]
Show your working. [2]
h Suggest one function of the circular
h Paul had been complaining of pain after
muscles. [1]
eating and so went to the doctor.
c State the part of the alimentary canal
The doctor wanted to find out if Paul was
where villi are located. [ 1]
allergic to any foods.
d Name three substances that pass from A
She asked Paul to eat two different foods at
on the diagram into the villus. [3]
each meal and record whether he suffered
e With reference to the diagram, explain
any pains afterwards.
the significance of diffusion and active
This is what he noted down.
transport in the alimentary canal. [4]
Food eaten Pain
2 The liver performs important functions in the Bread and butter yes
digestion and assimilation of food. One of these Bread and cheese yes
is the production of an alkaline digestive juice Cheese and biscuits yes
that breaks down large globules of fat. Cheese and cucumber no
a i Name the digestive juice secreted by Bread and cucumber yes
the liver. [ 1] i The doctor asked Paul to complete
ii Explain how this digestive juice reaches a chart.
the food in the small intestine. [2] Using Paul's note, copy and complete the
iii Explain why this digestive juice is chart according to the key given on the
alkaline. [2] next page. The result for bread and butter
has been done for you.
Food Energy/ kJ Animal protein / g Plant protein / g Calcium/ mg Iron/ mg Vitamin C / mg
Biscuits 2000 2 5 100 1.5 0
Bread 900 0 9 100 1.7 0
Butter 3000 0.5 0 15 0.2 0
Cheese 1600 26 0 800 0.4 0
Cucumber 40 0 0 25 0.3 8
A Table 1
83
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
0 The table below shows the effect of pH on 0 The table below shows the energy value of a
the time taken for the complete breakdown number of products from the Mars company.
of a starch solution in the presence of an a Copy and complete the table to show the
enzyme. energy value of each product in kJ per 100 g
(take care- some energy values are shown for
pH 5.0 5.5 6.0 6.5 7.0 7.5 8.0 9.0
25 g; others are for whole bars or packets).
Time taken/ 20.00 15.00 8.00 4.00 1.25 1.25 3.00 8.00
[2]
min
h Draw a bar chart showing the products in
Rate of
reaction descending order of energy value (the one
with the highest energy value on the left). [4]
a Copy and complete the table. Assume c For a SO g portion, which product would be:
that the rate of reaction is the same as
i the least fattening [ 1]
1
time taken [2] ii the most fattening? [1]
b Plot the results in the form of an appropriate d A Mars bar weighs 65 g. What is its energy
graph. [4] value in kilojoules? [ 1]
c What is the optimum pH for this enzyme?[l] e While sitting watching television, a boy of 1S
d Name one region of the gut where this uses about 6 kJ per minute.
pH would be found. How is this pH kept i How long would it take him to use all the
constant? [2] energy obtained from the Mars bar? [1]
e Suggest two chemical tests that could be ii What is he using this energy for? [1]
carried out on samples of the solution to f While playing football, the same boy uses,
show that starch is being broken down. [2] on average, 30 kJ per minute. How long
f In this experiment pH is the input or would it take him to use up the energy
independent variable, and rate of reaction obtained from the Mars bar? [1]
is the outcome or dependent variable. g A football match lasts for 90 minutes. If the
Suggest three fixed variables which must boy ran for half of the game, would he have
be kept constant if these results are to used more energy or less than the Mars bar
be valid. [3] provided? How could his body cope with
any difference between energy demanded
and energy supplied? [2]
Name of product Energy value / kJ Energy value/ kJ
per 25 g, unless per 100 g
otherwise stated
Bounty, 60 g 490
Maltesers 504
Mars 454
Milky Way 490
Minstrels, 49 g 870
Snickers 504
Treets, 42 g 1040
Twix 504
85
.
CHARACTERISTICS AND CLASSIFICATION OF LIVING ORGANISMS
Xytt'm t.is~ ronu11ns long xytnn ffSSCh Phloem IISS\J~ l'Otlllt m sictt ~ nd
Olmbium l1nuc Utt page UM)
adip1(d fo, the dfiid tr:i~l of wllt'"r and C'Offll)lUlion «It'- II ad.lpttd for lta"W()tt of
c-ontD ns rrik d:vfdr bV
dii_sofvtd minc'.,.I kins.
the sttfl\.
mtnt n 1-.l)'S ui,
mito,.i) o proou«
phi
"'°'
·mandxylan.
~ o,g 1tit' prodUCU of pholOS',11\htS&S i
~ (lr.i'"fM)flcd tutn ►stl nd ftfflf.n{I
s
Direction of transport varies with the seasons!
Sucrose is transported from stores in the root to leaves
in spring, but to stores in the root from photosynthesising
leaves in the summer and early autumn.
Whatever the time of year the movement of sugars and
Stem - vascular bundles are arranged
amino acids (translocation) is from source to sink. In
in a ring w ith soft cortex in the centre,
other words, sucrose and amino acids are translocated
helping to support the stem.
from the region where they are made or absorbed to the
region where they are stored or used.
Phloem
Vascular Root - root hairs are extended cells of
Xylem bundle the epidermis. • The transport tissues xylem
and phloem are arranged in
Epidermis - protects
against infection by vascu lar bundles. They transport
fungi.
water and dissolved substances
around the plant.
Cortex - cells become Phloem] Together form
turgid and help to support a strong central
non-woody parts.
Xylem rod.
®
1 Name the two vascular tissues in flowering plants. 4 Why must sugar be transported to sinks such as
Which tissue divides to form the vascular tissues? growing points and roots?
2 What is a source? Suggest two examples in a 0 Many dyes are water soluble. Xylem vessels reach up
flowering plant. from roots to flower petals. How could these two
3 Why does the direction of sugar transport vary from observations be useful to a florist?
season to season?
.
CHARACTERISTICS AND CLASSIFICATION OF LIVING ORGANISMS
2 Water (with any substances dissolved in it) is 3 Water crosses the living cells of 4 Water enters root hair cells by
forced to cross the membrane and cytoplasm of the cortex by (a) osmosis through osmosis, from the thin film of water
cells. The cell walls contain a waxy material the cells and (b) 'suction' through surrounding the particles of soil. The
which makes them impermeable to water. This the freely permeable cellulose cell soil water has a higher water
allows the membranes of the cells to select walls. Almost all of the water moves potential than the cytoplasm of the
which substances can enter the xylem and be across the cortex by route (b). root hair cell, so that water moves
distributed through the body of the plant. down a water potential gradient
(see page 32).
88
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
® 1 Does a solution containing many molecules of dissolved sugar and amino acids have a high or a low
water potential? Explain your answer.
2 Define osmosis in terms of water potential.
3 How does the strength of the cellulose cell wall help plants to support themselves?
0 A scientist investigated the uptake of magnesium ions by the roots of young cereal plants. He made the
following observations:
a The rate of uptake was increased by raising the temperature, so long as it did not exceed 40°C.
b Uptake stopped if the roots were treated with cyanide, an ion that prevents respiration.
c Ions were taken up even if they were present at a lower concentration in the solution around the roots
than in the root cells themselves.
d If ion uptake continued for some time, the concentration of sugars in the root cells decreased.
What conclusions can be drawn from each of these observations?
89
.
CHARACTERISTICS AND CLASSIFICATION OF LIVING ORGANISMS
Water movement through a plant begins with the diffusion of water vapour out of the leaf and evaporation from
the leaf surface (spongy mesophyll). 98% of the water taken up by a plant is lost to the atmosphere by transpiration.
s
Leaf cells have a layer of
moisture to aid diffusion of
carbon dioxide into the cells.
Flooding of soil with salt water lowers the water potential of the
soil solution and prevents osmosis - no water uptake by roots.
go
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
The lower surface is less exposed to the warming effects of the Sun's
radiation, which would speed up the evaporation rate. Loss of water
from the leaf is shown in the diagram on the opposite page.
Water cannot diffuse into the leaf through the stomata, because the
air spaces inside the leaf are completely saturated. Instead, water
must be absorbed from the soil solution and drawn up through the
plant (see page 88). This flow of water through the plant to replace
the losses by evaporation from the leaf is called the transpiration
stream, shown in the diagram on the opposite page.
Transpiration is affected by leaf strncture and by conditions in
the atmosphere because water is lost through the stomata to the
atmosphere (see opposite). These factors can be investigated using
the potometer shown below.
Leaf structure may reduce transpiration Atmospheric conditions may affect transpiration
• Thick, waxy cuticle reduces evaporation from epidermis.
• Wind moves humid air away from the leaf surface and increases
• Stomata may be sunk into pits which trap a pocket of humid air. transpiration.
• Leaves may be rolled w ith the stomata on the inner surface close • High temperatures increase t he water-holding capacity of the air
~,~)
to a trapped layer of humid air. and increase transpiration.
• Low humidity increases the water potential gradient betwee
leaf and atmosphere and increases transpiration.
\~ air / / • Highlight intensity causes stomata to open (to allow
~ photosynthesis) which allows transpiration to occur.
• Leaves may be needle shaped to reduce their surface area.
Cobalt chloride paper is blue when dry, and pink when wet. then left in a drying atmosphere for 48 hours, and reweighed
It is handled with forceps to avoid moisture from the fingers at intervals. Some typical results from th is investigation are
affecting its colour. The paper is attached to the upper and shown in the table.
lower leaf surfaces using microscope slides. The paper
attached to the lower surface of the leaf turns pink, showing
Leaf Initial Final Percentage
that water is lost main ly from the lower surface. Th is number mass I g mass I g change in mass
technique gives a qualitative (non-quantitative) comparison.
4.2 4.1
Measuring the mass changes of leaves can be used to give a 2 4.6 4.4
quantitative comparison of water loss from different leaf
3 3.9 2.5
surfaces. A number of leaves are smeared with petroleum
jelly as shown in the diagram below. They are weighed and
4 4.1 2.5
._ These measurements are made on leaves which have been detached from the plant. It is difficult to measure water loss from the
leaves of an intact plant but relatively simple to measure water uptake using a potometer (see page 91).
® Questions 1 to 4 refer to the investigation above. 3 Why was it important that leaves of the same species
1 Copy the table above. Calculate the percentage were used?
change in mass for each leaf. 0 How could the results be made more reliable or valid?
2 Why did leaf 3 lose a greater proportion of its mass
than leaf 2?
92
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
l - - - - - - - Polythene bag
_,_.,.__ _ _ _ _ Plant pot
,,__ _ _ _ _ Balance
I 1 I •
Day 2 3 4 5 6 7
Loss of mass/ g 3.2 3.8 4.9 6.7 4.6 7.9 5.1
95
.
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
OBJECTIVES
Large complex organisms, such as humans, have
■ To understand why animals need a circulatory system
a small surface area in relation to their relatively
■ To know that a transport system has four components large volume. As a result, cells near the centre of
■ To know the structure and functions of the components the body are some distance away from contact
of the blood
with the atmosphere, and may also be some
distance from the gut where food is digested. Cells
All living organisms require energy, which is inside such large organisms cannot gain enough
released from food and oxygen in the process of oxygen and glucose by diffusion alone.
respiration (page 122). All living cells in the body
(for example in the brain, liver, kidney and muscle) A mass flow system
need energy, and so glucose and oxygen must be To supply oxygen and glucose, as well as other
transported throughout the body. In some small substances, large organisms have a specialised
animals (especially those with a flat body such transport system. This system, called the blood
as the flatworm in the photograph), substances are system in all vertebrate animals, is an example of
transported in and out of the body, and from one a mass flow system. A mass flow system carries
tissue to another, by the process of diffusion. large volumes of fluid to all parts of the organism.
A system like this has four parts:
■ A medium - the fluid that flows in the system
and carries materials around the body. This is
the blood.
■ A system of tubes that carries the fluid from
place to place. These are the arteries and
veins.
■ A pump that supplies pressure to keep
the fluid moving through the tubes. This
is the heart.
■ Sites of exchange that allow materials
A The flatworm is very thin and has a high surface area to
delivered by the blood to enter the tissues that
volume ratio. Its volume is made up of working cells that
need various substances including oxygen, which can diffuse
need them. These are the capillaries.
in across the large surface. The distance from the surface to 'Y A whale has a large surface area, but its volume is too
all the cells is small. large for materials to be moved to and from its body cells by
diffusion. The blue whale has a circulatory system made up of
4000 dm 3 of blood, pumped through 50 000 km of blood
vessels by a heart the size of a small car.
96
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
Blood is the circulatory medium Blood cells are first formed in the bone marrow
The average adult human has about 5 dm3 of of long bones such as the femur (thigh bone),
blood, which contains a number of blood cells although they might be transported to other parts
suspended in a watery liquid (plasma). If a of the body before they become fully developed.
sample of blood taken from the body is allowed to The structure and function of different types of
stand, and a chemical added to prevent it clotting, blood cell are shown in the table below.
it will separate into layers as shown opposite.
If a drop of blood is placed on a microscope slide Plasma: 55% of volume
and stained with a special dye, these different types
of cell can be seen, as the photograph below shows.
- - W hit e blood cells
Cells: 45% of volume and platelets
A The red blood cells sink to the bottom, and the white
A Red blood cel ls are shown in pink; white blood cells have blood cells and platelets settle on top of the red blood cells.
purple-stained nuclei, of several different shapes (platelets The plasma forms a clear, straw-coloured layer at the top.
are not visible)
Cell type Appearance Function How the structure is suited to the function
Red blood cells Transport oxygen from lungs Contain haemoglobin, an iron-containing pigment
(erythrocytes) to all respiring tissues. Prepare which picks up oxygen at the lungs and lets go of
carbon dioxide for transport it at the tissues.
from all respiring tissues to Have no nucleus, leaving more space for haemoglobin.
lungs. Cells are small and flexible, so can squeeze through
narrow capillaries.
White blood cells Remove any microorganisms Irregular shaped nucleus allows cell to squeeze s
(phagocytes) that invade the body and through gaps in wa lls of capillaries.
. .. . . . might cause infection. Enzymes in cytoplasm digest microorganisms
.. . The phagocyte engulfs once engulfed .
.
. . . . .. the microorganism (see Sensitive cell surface membrane can
... page 116). detect microorganisms.
White blood cells Produce antibodies - Large nucleus contains many copies of genes for the
(lymphocytes) proteins that help in the control of antibody protein production.
defence against disease
(see page 118).
Platelets Cell fragments involved in Can release blood-clotting enzymes (see page 116).
o aao a blood clotting.
tJ Ot'
0 0 0
aP
<1
a aP
I
97
9.1 Transport systems in animals use blood as the transport medium
Water plays a part in t he distribution of heat between Too much alcohol in the
heat-producing areas such as t he liver and areas of blood can cause water to
heat loss such as the skin . leave brain cells, causing
pain and the sensation
Blood also helps to mainta in an optimum pH of thirst.
in t he tissues.
Protective functions
Platelets, plasma proteins (e.g . fibrinogen) and many other plasma factors (e.g . Ca 2+ ions)
protect against blood loss and t he entry of pathogens by the clotting mechanism .
Transport functions
Soluble products of digestion/absorption (such as g lucose, am ino acids, fatty acids, vitamins
and minerals) are t ransported from the gut to t he liver and then to t he general circulation.
Waste products of metabolism (such as urea, creatinine and lactate) are t ransported from
sites of production to sites of removal, such as t he liver and kid ney.
Respiratory gases (oxygen and carbon dioxide) are transported from their sites of uptake
or prod uction to t heir site of use o r removal.
Hormones (such as insulin) are transported from t heir sites of production in t he glands to
the target organs w here they have t heir effects.
Support function
Erection of t he penis is achieved by filling large spongy spaces w ith blood. The penis
becomes soft when blood flows o ut more q uickly t han it flows in.
98
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
A Using modern techniques of biochemistry, a A Sickle-shaped red blood cells show the
single drop of blood can yield information about person has sickle cell anaemia. A sickle is a long
all the conditions described in this box hooked tool used for cutting crops.
@
1 Why do large organisms require a transport system? b Which person would be the most likely to become ill
2 A sample of human blood is collected and placed in a if exposed to a virus? Explain your answer.
tube and centrifuged. The blood separates into two c Which person's blood is least likely to clot efficiently?
distinct layers. Explain your answer.
a What are the two layers? d Which person is likely to have an iron deficiency in
b Suggest one dissolved food substance found in the her diet? Explain your answer.
upper layer. Choose a substance for which there e These three samples were all taken from 23-year-old
is a simple chemical test. Describe the test for women. Explain why this makes comparisons
this substance, and state what a positive result between them valid.
would be. 5 Use words from this list to complete the following
c There is a third, rather thin, layer between the two paragraphs. The words may be used once, more than
main components. What is this layer made of? once or not at all.
3 'The structure of a cell is closely related to its function.' Is epidermis, tissues, specialised, cells, blood, red blood
this statement correct for blood cells? Explain your answer. cell, division of labour, organ
0 The table shows the cell composition of three samples
Large numbers of _ _ that have the same structure and
of blood.
Sample from function are grouped together to form - -·, for example
_ _ Several separate tissues may be joined together to
Cell count I Jill Jenny Jackie
form an _ _ which is a complex structure capable of
number per mm3
performing a particular task with great efficiency.
Red blood cells 7 500 000 5 000 000 2 000 000
The structure of cells may be highly adapted to perform
White blood cells 500 6000 5000 one function, i.e. the cells may become _ _ One
Platelets 250 000 255 000 50 excellent example is the _ _ which is highly adapted
a Which person is most likely to have lived at high to carry oxygen in mammalian blood. If the different
altitude recently? Explain your answer. cells, tissues and organs of a multicellular organism
perform different functions they are said to show _ _
99
.
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
Vein Thin Flap of watch ■ Carries blood from the tissues to the heart.
outer wall pocket valve ■ Blood is at low pressure.
■ Blood is low in oxygen, high in carbon dioxide
(except in the pulmonary vein).
■ Valves prevent the backflow of blood. Blood is at low
S pressure, but nearby muscles squeeze the veins and help
I h! push blood back towards the heart.
~ T~)'P
s;. ~,.,,
High pressure - both ventricles pump out blood at high pressure, but t he 'body' circu it has a
pressure about Sx t hat in t he 'lung' (pu lmonary) circu it. This is because blood in t he body circuit
Pulmonary artery - unlike other has so far to travel, and t here are many branches in t he circuit to take the high-pressure blood .
arteries, this vessel carries
deoxygenated blood which also has
a high carbon dioxide concentration. Too high! If pressure in the pulmonary
artery is too high, tissue f luid or plasma
◄· .. Head ~
can leak into the lungs. This sometimes
\J
The heart (see also page 104)
)
~
Right
atrium
Left
J
... --
I
I
r Arms
happens to climbers at high altitude.
I
Liver
---- Hepatic artery - carries
oxygenated blood to t he liver.
7 6
Hepatic portal vein - carries
Hepatic vein - returns blood w it h : blood containing va riable amounts
a reg ulated, optimum concentration _ _.__, I
, ~ - - - - - - - 1 - - . - - - of t he absorbed products of
of food substances to the circulation. digestion from t he digestive system
Digestive system to t he liver.
7
Renal vein - blood w ith red uced
urea concentration is returned to the - +---~ Renal artery - carries oxygenated
circulation. blood w it h a high concentration of
urea to t he kidneys.
, ..
I
--
I
Key
101
.
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
Capillary has:
• wall only one cell thick
■ very large surface area.
Formation of lymph
®
0 This diagram represents a group of body cells and some parts
of the circulatory system. The arrows show movement of fluids. A
a Name the fluids contained in spaces A, B and C.
b Name two substances that the cells remove from the fluid in B.
Suggest two substances that the cells might add to the fluid in B. Blood
c Describe how the fluid in C is returned to the circulation. capillary
103
.
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
T
blood returning from t he lungs. Atria
blood running back into the
~ have thin walls because they need only
ventricles when pressure falls
during relaxation.
'y' pump blood to the ventricles.
Remember that:
■ The atrium receives blood at low pressure Artificial pacemakers - help for 0
from the veins ( coming from the lungs or the heart
tissues). The beating of the heart is controlled by the natural
■ The ventricle pumps blood at high pressure pacemaker in the wall of the right atrium. If this
out to the arteries (to the lungs or tissues). pacemaker is damaged, pumping goes on automatically
■ Valves make sure that the blood flows in the at about 30 beats per minute. This is less than half the
right direction. normal rate, and is only enough to keep a very inactive
person alive.
The beating of the heart is controlled An artificial pacemaker can help people whose natural
by a pacemaker pacemaker does not work well. This artificial pacemaker
In a healthy person, the heart beats about 70 is made up of a box containing batteries and an electronic
timing device. It is placed in a cavity under the muscle
times a minute during normal levels of activity.
of the upper chest as shown below, and a wire is fed
This rate is enough to supply blood containing
down a vein into the right ventricle. The timing device
oxygen and nutrients to tissues. sends a small electrical charge which triggers the
The muscular walls of the heart differ from beating of the heart. This is set to give a basic rate of
other muscles in that they never become tired or 72 beats per minute. The latest pacemakers can sense
fatigued, because each contraction of the heart is changes in breathing, movement and body temperature,
and make exactly the right adjustments to heart rate.
immediately followed by a relaxation. Even when
The battery in the pacemaker is usually replaced every
the heart is beating at its fastest during severe year or so, under local anaesthetic.
exercise (see page 132), the period of relaxation
allows the muscle to recover so it does not fatigue. Vein
®1 a Name the chamber of the heart that receives blood 0 A doctor listening to the heartbeat through a
from the lungs. stethoscope hears two sounds as the blood flows
b Explain what happens to the blood in the ventricles through the heart: 'lup-dup lup-dup lup-dup'.
when the muscle in the ventricle walls contracts. a From your knowledge of the working of the heart,
c The muscle around the atria is thinner than the suggest how these two sounds are produced.
muscle around the ventricles. Suggest a reason b The doctor records 72 beats per minute. How long a
for this. period would there be between two consecutive
'lup' sounds? Explain your answer.
105
.
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
Anyone with a genetic risk of developing heart If a doctor suspects that a patient has CHO, an
disease should obviously take care that h e or angiogram is carried out . This gives a picture of the
sh e does not have a poor diet or lifestyle. Many state of these arteries (see below). If the coronary
middle-aged m en , the highest risk group, help to arteries are blocked, a coronary artery bypass
prevent heart disease by taking half an aspirin a operation may be carried out, as shown below.
day (this seem s to h elp stop small clots forming
which could block th e ar teries) a nd/or by drinking
a small qua ntity of alcohol (red win e may b e the Avoid the
most beneficial). problem!
• Don't smoke
• Avoid fatty foods
Aortic arch - - - - - • Take regular
aerobic exercise
Grafted 'bypass' - - -
Men are more at risk of CHD than women - but men
can't avoid CHD by changing their gender!
Blocked part of
coronary artery --- s In a coronary artery bypass operation a blood vessel is
removed from another part of the body and stitched into
place between the aorta and the unblocked part of the
coronary artery. Sometimes an artificial vessel is used. The
bypass increases blood flow and reduces the likelihood of
angina (chest pain).
Coronary artery _ ____,,
® 1 a The heart muscle has its own supply of blood from vessels that CII
Graph A
run all over its surface. What is the name of these vessels? Cl.I "'
,a 20
~ E
B shows the relationship between cholesterol levels and age,
for men and women . -...0 0
0 2 3 4 5
Blood cholesterol / arbitrary units
6 7 8
107
1 Which is the correct pathway taken by blood to the lungs [ 1]
flowing through the human circulatory system? ii the vessel taking blood from the heart
A body ➔ vena cava ➔ left atrium ➔ left to organs such as the liver. [ 1]
ventricle ➔ lungs
5 Diagram A shows a sample of human blood,
B left ventricle ➔ aorta ➔ body ➔ vena cava ➔
collected and spun to separate the different
right atrium
components.
C lungs ➔ pulmonary artery ➔ left atrium ➔
left ventricle ➔ aorta
D right ventricle ➔ aorta ➔ lungs ➔ body ➔
right atrium [1]
2 In a single circulation of a fish, the blood flows
through the heart once during a complete
circulation of the body. What type of blood White blood cells
leaves the heart?
A Deoxygenated blood at high pressure Red blood cells
B Deoxygenated blood at low pressure
C Oxygenated blood at high pressure
D Oxygenated blood at low pressure [1] A Diagram A
3 Management of coronary heart disease may
a Diagram A is drawn to scale.
involve a number of actions. Which one of the
Calculate the percentage of red cells,
following is the treatment of CHO?
white cells and plasma in whole blood.
A Angioplasty
Show your working. [3]
B Eating more saturated fats
h Name two dissolved substances that
C Putting stents into coronary arteries
would be present in the plasma. [2]
D Taking more exercise [1] c Diagram B shows three types of cell
4 The diagram below shows a section through a found in human blood.
human heart.
A B C
A Diagram B
108
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
In infected water e.g. Cholera bacteria In droplets in the air e.g. influenza virus,
SARS-CoV-2 (coronavirus)
By animal vectors e.g. Plasmodium Via body fluids e.g. hepatitis B virus or
protoctist (causes malaria) via Anopheles human immunodeficiency virus (HIV)
mosquito (causes AIDS)
• Infectious diseases. Parasites such as tapeworms and head lice are not considered to cause 'diseases' by some
people, but they do cause distress to the person affected by them and the body is less 'at ease' when it has been
110
colonised by such a parasite. Parasites may be thought of as causing long-term disease.
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
Non-Infectious diseases
Degenerative - organs and tissues work less well as they age. This
is thought to be due to changes in body chemicals caused by free
radicals such as the peroxide ion e.g. heart attacks, cataracts, \------.I
hardening of the arteries.
improved public hygiene, deaths from infectious the vector can live and breed. In the same way,
diseases in the UK are now much less common. diseases spread by the number of people likely
Smallpox was a major killer worldwide until the to meet an infected individual. In recent years,
1960s, but effective vaccination has now eliminated there has been concern over the possible spread of
this disease (see page 114). infectious diseases because:
In the Western world, the major killers are now ■ Easier travel by air means that diseases can
'diseases of affluence', caused by our relatively be carried from one country to another before
wealthy lifestyle. Along with accidents, coronary the infected person develops any symptoms,
heart disease and cancer cause most deaths in the e.g. COVID-19 caused by coronavirus infection.
UK, largely the result of smoking, eating too many ■ Global warming has increased the range of
sugary and fatty foods, and lack of exercise. some insect vectors.
Infectious diseases that are spread by vectors ■ A greater dependence on communal eating and
(e.g. malaria spread by mosquitoes) are naturally fast food has led to the easier transmission of
confined to those parts of the world in which organisms that cause food poisoning.
® 1 Suggest th ree ways in which microbes might 4 What is the difference between the signs and the
be harmful to humans, and three ways in which symptoms of a disease? What are the causes of
they might be helpful. Give examples to support 'typical' disease symptoms?
your suggestions. 5 Suggest why measles is very rarely fatal in the UK yet
2 Suggest three causes of non-infectious diseases, and still ranks among the top five killer diseases in the
give one example of each. developing world.
3 How can infectious diseases spread? Give examples to 6 How have changes in human lifestyle contributed to
support your answer. the spread of infectious diseases?
111
.
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
Viruses
Viruses are responsible for many of the most
To recall that a pathogen is an organism that serious human diseases. Viruses differ from the
causes disease true living organisms in that they cannot survive
■ To give examples of different types of pathogen and the and reproduce outside the cells of their host -
diseases they cause every virus is a parasite. The structure of viruses
was described on page 18. Remember that viruses
Pathogens are parasites are so small that they can pass through filters and
Any organism that affects the body to cause screens which will trap any other organism. We
disease is a pathogen (or pathogenic organism). use an electron microscope to study viruses.
Pathogens are parasites, that is, they live on the Bacterial diseases
body of a host and cause it some harm: The structure of bacteria and their importance to
■ by secreting poisons (toxins) - this is
humans are outlined on page 292. Some bacteria
especially common from bacteria. The cause serious human diseases, cholera (see page
toxins have different effects, for example the 110) and TB for example.
organism Clostridium botulinum produces
a deadly nerve poison, whereas bacteria of TB is now the infectious disease that causes most
deaths worldwide, due to:
the Salmonella group release a toxin which
■ poor disease control programmes
irritates the lining of the gut.
■ resistance to antibiotics (see page 174)
■ as a result of multiplication - the organism
■ co-infection with HIV
may reproduce quickly and produce such a
■ a rapid increase in the population of young
large colony that it damages cells directly, as
adults, the age group most at risk from TB.
in malaria, or it uses up compounds which
should be used by the host cell, as in polio. Any bacterial disease can be treated with
Many viruses multiply and cause host cells antibiotics.
to burst.
■ as a result of the immune response - when
Controlling the spread of disease
the host detects pathogens, it directs more Transmissable diseases are caused by pathogens
blood to the site of infection. This can cause so controlling these diseases often involves
swelling and soreness, and usually causes a preventing the spread of these organisms.
rise in body temperature. Important techniques include:
■ hygienic food preparation (see opposite)
There are many pathogens that are parasites on ■ good personal hygiene
humans, causing diseases. The following table ■ waste disposal (page 286)
illustrates the range of pathogenic organisms. ■ sewage treatment (page 282).
Pathogen type Size Disease in Individuals and communities all contribute to the
humans control of disease.
Virus About 1nm Influenza
(1/1000 µm) AIDS
Bacterium (prokaryote) About 1µm Cholera
Food poisoning
Protoctist Up to 1mm Dysentery
Malaria
Fungus May be Athlete's foot
extensive Ringworm
'Worms' Up to several Tapeworm
112 meters Toxocara
• ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
®1 State which of the following is least likely to cause 2 One of the symptoms of food poisoning is diarrhoea.
food poisoning. Explain what causes this condition. Suggest why the
A Raw crabmeat condition is so dangerous.
B Ice cream
C Roast meat
D Raw fish
113
.
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
Community responsibility
Living close together in towns and cities means
To understand that the fight against disease involves
we share many facilities which affect our health.
several levels of responsibility
■ To provide examples of individual, community and Community health responsibilities include:
worldwide responsibi Iities ■ Providing safe drinking water and treating
sewage (see page 282)
■ removing refuse (see diagrams below and
The fight against disease has three levels: opposite)
■ personal - for example, each individual can take
■ providing medical care for the unwell
responsibility for his or her own social habits ■ monitoring standards of health and hygiene.
■ communities - for example, local health
services must be correctly managed and Worldwide responsibility
financed The World Health Organization (WHO) aims to
■ worldwide - for example, many nations carry raise the level of health of all the citizens of the
out vaccination programmes (see page 119). world so that they can lead socially productive
lives. They have had some successes:
Personal responsibility ■ reduction in infant mortality, by providing a
The individual can reduce his or her chances of better diet for mothers and their infants
contracting some diseases by: ■ elimination of smallpox, by a well-coordinated
■ having good personal hygiene
vaccination programme
■ eating a balanced diet
■ reduction in malaria, by a variety of control
■ taking regular exercise
measures such as draining swamps
■ not smoking
■ improved provision of safe water, by the
■ controlling alcohol intake.
construction of water-treatment plants.
Refuse disposal in land-fill sites
Advantages Disadvantages
■ Can help land reclamation, e.g. in filling ■ Sites can attract pests, such as flies,
old quarry workings. rats and gulls. These might spread disease
■ Can be made economical in terms of space: (e.g. flies contaminate food) or leave a mess
- lorries use rams to compress rubbish (e.g. gulls leave droppings).
- very deep pits can be used. ■ Ecologically important areas such as marshes and
■ Can be situated well away from residential heathland may be used as dumps.
areas, reducing impact of smells and
unsightly rubbish. Refuse may be buried under O.Sm of soil. This
■ reduces access by pests
■ allows bacteria and fungi to decompose
organic compounds
■ generates biogas which can be used to fuel
machinery.
114
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
Advantages Disadvantages
■ Incineration plant is quite small - --,,..,'1:::1..._ ■ May generate toxic fumes
so valuable land not used. (especially from burn ing plastics).
■ No attraction to pests so less - - ■ Can be very expensive to build .
risk of disease. ■ Seepage of wastes may
■ Heat generated can be used - pollute groundwater.
incinerators built as part of ■ Fuel is consumed to beg in the
housing projects can save energy. - - combustion process.
A Open rubbish dumps are a source of infection. Waste food is infected with harmful microbes,
which may be spread by rats, birds such as the Marabou stork, and humans.
® 1 Suggest two steps an individual can take to reduce the 3 Name one viral and one bacterial sexually transmitted
risk of a named disease. infection (STI).
2 What are the responsibilities of a community 4 For any one named STI suggest how individuals, local
health service? communities and scientists worldwide might be
involved in its control.
115
.
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
Torn capillaries
Release enzymes
Inherited defects
in blood protein
production cause
severe bleeding
(haemophilia).
Fibrinogen, an
inactive blood •----►► Fibrin, an activated
protein blood protein
S Phagocyte action
~ -
, ••-1.
lnfected tissue
surface, and they are recognised and destroyed by disorganised. They can destroy lung tissue rather
phagocytes and by antibodies. Phagocytes engulf than foreign particles, leading to the disease
and then destroy the pathogens with digestive emphysema (see page 135).
enzymes, as outlined above. Antibodies are
described on page 118. ® 1 Suggest how the skin may limit the entry of
There are many phagocytes present in areas of pathogens to the body. Why is it necessary to
the body likely to suffer infection. The exposed prevent the entry of pathogens?
surfaces of the lungs, for example, are patrolled 0 This question concerns the process of blood clotting.
a Why might blood clotting be necessary?
by phagocytes. If the lungs are regularly attacked
b When could blood clotting be a disadvantage?
by the free radicals in tobacco smoke, large c Blood clotting occurs in a number of stages. This is
numbers of phagocytes collect and may become quite common in biological processes, because it
First aid can save lives 0 allows amplification. Each step produces a
product which can trigger many repeats of the next
Severe blood loss, or haemorrhage, can cause a number step - for example, each enzyme molecule released
of problems. Following an accident there may be so from a platelet can catalyse the conversion of 100
much blood loss that the blood pressure falls to inactive protein molecules to their active form.
dangerously low levels. This may affect the function i Suggest how this amplification might be an
of vital organs such as the heart, brain and kidney.
advantage in a rapid response to wounding.
If the victim has no pulse or is not breathing, steps are ii If there were five steps, each allowing an
taken to restart these essential functions. amplification of 100, how many 'product'
If there is considerable bleeding, the first-aider applies molecules would be present at the end of the
firm pressure to the site of the injury. The victim should complete process for each 'signal' molecule
not be moved unless he or she is in danger. No attempt released at the start of the process?
should be made to clean wounds - this may force 3 Describe the process of phagocytosis. Suggest two
a foreign body such as a glass fragment deeper into ways in which the structure of a phagocyte is related
the wound. to its function. Suggest two ways in which a
Organisations such as St John Ambulance in the UK pathogen might avoid phagocytosis.
provide training in first aid.
117
. ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
Scientists estimate that humans can make This end of the antibody acts
up to 1 000 000 different antibodies - as a signal to destroy
enough to account for every pathogen or the pathogen.
'foreign' substance we might ever meet!
118
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
Some problems with the immune ■ matching tissues wherever possible, for example
response by seeking out relatives of people needing bone
The activity of the immune system saves all our marrow transplants, because relatives are more
lives, many times over. There are occasions, likely to have similar antigens to the recipient.
however, when it may actually reduce the
Monoclonal antibodies
likelihood of survival. These are described below.
Scientists need a good supply of 'pure' antibodies
Autoimmune diseases are caused by the body to work with. They produce these by combining
producing antibodies which destroy its own cells. the properties of two types of cell:
Why this should happen is not known. An example
■ lymphocytes are very efficient at producing
is Type I diabetes where the body destroys its own
anitbodies but cannot be grown in large
insulin-producing cells by an immune reaction.
numbers outside the human body
Transplant rejection - the most common organ ■ tumour cells cannot produce antibodies but
transplant in Britain is the kidney transplant divide very well in artificial culture.
(see page 143), but heart, intestine, lung, liver Cells formed by joining together lymphocytes and
and pancreas transplants are becoming more tumour cells - called hybridomas - can produce
common. The recipient's lymphocytes may enormous quantities of one desirable kind of
recognise antigens on the surface of the donor antibody and survive for long periods in artificial
organ as foreign and slowly destroy it. This culture. The antibodies produced in this way are
problem of rejection is being overcome by: called monoclonal antibodies ('mono' means
■ drugs that suppress the immune system of the one type and 'clonal' means a group of identical
recipient long enough to allow the transplanted dividing cells). They have many uses in medicine,
organ to become established industry and research.
ra O 5
------
C1----,--~~----~-~---~-~-
10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 so 55
. ♦ .
contaminated with microorganisms. [2] lnJect1on Time / days Sectnd
of antigen injection of antigen
c Some diseases are transmitted in food and tl
water. State four other ways in which ·2 Method B
-::::1
0 >,
infectious diseases can be transmitted. [4] C._
0~
·,.::; .'!::
4 a Give three natural ways in which the body
~
......
ra .Cl
ra
can prevent the entry of pathogens. [3] Cll-
u >,
~
rise to 40 000 per mm3 of blood.
120
B memory cells Plasma cells Four different types of T cells
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
In a healthy person living at sea level, there a Explain why no antibodies were present in
are about 5 000 000 red blood cells per mm3 of the blood for the first week. [2]
blood. The cells are regularly replaced from the h The response to the two injections of the
bone marrow. Old, worn-out red blood cells are vaccine is different.
removed from the blood by the liver, after about Use the information in the graph to describe
120 days of carrying out their function. Each and explain how the response to the booster
cell canies oxygen from the lungs to the tissues, at eight months differs from the response to
combined with a protein called haemoglobin. the first injection at four months. [2]
Haemoglobin will also combine with carbon c Suggest why further boosters of this vaccine
monoxide, a gas in car exhaust fumes and may be given. [2]
cigarette smoke. Carbon monoxide combines with 7 The diagram below shows four different
haemoglobin about 250 times more readily than antigens and an antibody molecule.
oxygen does, and the combination does not break
w X
down.
a Name two soluble substances transported
in the blood plasma. For each substance you
name, suggest where it might be coming
from and where it might be going to. [4]
b What is the maximum number of white blood
cells normally found in 1 mm3 of blood?
What can cause this number to increase? [2]
a The antibody forms a complex with one of
c In a healthy person, what is the ratio of
the antigens.
red blood cells to white blood cells? [1]
State which one and explain your answer. [2]
d Name two sources of carbon monoxide. [2]
h There is no vaccine for chicken pox. A child
e What happens to the amount of oxygen
has been vaccinated against several diseases
transported if a person breathes in carbon
including measles, tetanus and rubella.
monoxide? Explain your answer. [2]
The child catches chicken pox and has the
f How long would it take the blood of the
symptoms of the disease.
person in part e to regain its full ability
i Use the information in the diagram to
to carry oxygen? Explain your answer. [2]
explain why it is possible to be immune
g Liver is a good dietary source of iron. Why?
to many diseases, but still be ill with
[1]
another disease, such as chicken pox. [3]
6 A child received a first vaccination against ii Some people see that certain diseases
measles at four months of age and then a are becoming rare and believe that there
booster at eight months. The concentration of is no longer any need for vaccination.
antibodies to measles is shown in the graph. Suggest why vaccination against diseases
must continue to be carried out even
if there are no cases of the disease for
many years. [2]
8 Which row in the table shows the correct
functions of the components of the blood?
Plasma Red blood cells Platelets
A transport of ions clotting oxygen transport
B antibody formation oxygen transport clotting
C transport of ions oxygen transport clotting
D oxygen transport clotting antibody formation
0 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
[1]
Time/ months
121
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
Photosynthesis Respiration
in green plants in all cells
Active transport: moving molecules
Light against a concentration gradient,
energy ENERGY
e.g. ion uptake by roots.
® 1 True or False.
Movement: contraction of muscle
requires energy. The supply of
energy will run out if food or
a Most of the energy in our diet is used for movement. oxygen is limited.
b Ions only move from the intestine to the blood by diffusion.
122
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
A B
.
- ... '1•
_·_ Equal masses
... of peas
-::::-:---- Cotton wool
plugs: support Dead peas, killed by
Living peas, thermometers and allow boiling or by strong
previously soaked disinfectant
gas exchange between
in water and washed flask contents and
with dilute disinfectant
surroundings
_ _ _ _ _ Thermometers: positioned so
that they can be read without
removal from flask
123
ORGANISATION AND MAIN T ENANCE OF ORGANISMS
carbon
gl ucose + oxygen ➔ energy + d. .d + water
lOXl
C6H 12 0 6 + 60 2 ➔ energy + 6C0 2 + 6H2 0
e
®1 One of the comparisons between aerobic and
anaerobic respiration shown below is incorrect.
The oxygen comes from the air. It is taken in at Which one?
the lungs and carried around the body in the
blood, pumped by the heart. Glucose comes from Respiration
food digested in the gut, and is also carried in the Aerobic Anaerobic
blood. Muscles have extensive capillary beds to A Uses oxygen gas Does not use oxygen gas
supply glucose and oxygen for respiration, and to B Produces ethanol or Produces no ethanol or
carry away carbon dioxide. The blood also carries lactic acid lactic acid
away heat that is produced during respiration. C Large amount of energy Small amount of energy
released released
Anaerobic respiration D Mitochondria involved Mitochondria not involved
When we work very hard our muscles use up a lot E Carbon dioxide always Carbon dioxide sometimes
of energy. The heart and lungs, even working flat produced produced
out, cannot supply enough oxygen to provide this
energy by aerobic respiration. Muscles can release 0 What is meant by energy transformation? Briefly
energy from food without using oxygen by a describe one energy transformation that is important
process called anaerobic respiration: the release to living organ isms. What eventually happens to al l
of energy from glucose in the absence of oxygen. of the energy taken in by living organisms?
124
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
The diagram below shows the part played by aerobic and anaerobic respiration during rest, exercise and recovery.
Rest - all respiration is aerobic. Hard exercise - respiration is Recovery - paying off the oxygen debt. The
Normal breathing and heart mainly anerobic. Very high breathing and heart rates remain high, even
rates can supply the tissues breathing and heart rates still though the muscles are at rest. The extra
with all the oxygen they need, cannot provide the muscles oxygen is used to convert the lactic acid
Glucose + oxygen ➔ energy + with enough oxygen for into carbon dioxide and water, paying off
carbon dioxide + water aerobic respiration. the oxygen debt.
Glucose ➔ energy + lactic
Heart rate acid Heart rate
70 beats per minute 140 beats per minute
falling to normal
Heart rate
Breathing after some minutes
140 beats per minute
15 breaths per minute
Breathing Breathing
SO breaths per minute 50 breaths per minute
falling to normal after
some minutes
s
"'O
·;::; Rest Exercise Recovery
Ill
V
tlIll This is the 'extra'
"'O oxygen required to
Anaerobic respiration
C
Ill
No lactic acid builds pay off the oxygen is important in other organ isms
C
QI
C'I up because t here is debt. such as yeast, for b rewing and
~
-0
0
VI
Qi
enough oxygen for
aerobic respiration.
baking (page 298)
G l ucose ➔ alcohol + carbon dioxide
> C6 H12 0 6 ➔ 2C 2 H50H + 2(02
QI
"'O
0
0
ai
Oxygen _;1 This is t he shortfall
in oxygen - making
lactic acid builds up
Lactic acid an oxygen debt.
Time / min
.A. Trained athletes can exercise for longer than people who do not usually exercise before they bu ild up an oxygen debt
®0 The concentration of lactic acid in the blood of a a Plot this information in the for m of a graph .
r unner was measured at intervals before, during and b What was the lactic acid concentration at the end of
after she ran for 10 minutes. The results are shown in the run?
the table below. c For how long did the concentration of lactic acid
increase after the end of the run?
Time/ Concentration of
minutes lactic acid / arbitrary units
d Why did the blood still contain lactic acid after
the run?
0 18
10 18 e In wh ich tissues was the lactic acid produced?
125
.
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
The equation for anaerobic respiration in yeast (page yeast suspansion "--------/
in boiled, cooked
125) shows that carbon dioxide is released. The sugar solution
2 MEASUREMENT OF OXYGEN
CONSUMPTION USING A RESPIROMETER
S The effect of
The apparatus shown in the diagram on the next page is used.
temperature on
a A measured mass of living organisms is put in the chamber.
b First, the spring clip is open, so that an equilibrium of temperature and respiration can be
pressure is set up between the chamber and the surroundings. investigated using
c After five minutes or so, the spring clip is closed and the movement of the this apparatus. The
coloured liquid along the capillary tube is observed. The time taken for it to respiratory chamber
move a measured length along the tube is noted.
can be placed in a
d The living organisms are removed and the experiment is repeated.
thermostatically
Using this apparatus, a group of students obtained the following data.
controlled water bath
Experiment Distance Time Relative oxygen consumption / and the measurements
moved /mm taken Is mm per s made at a series of
1 Seeds 39 100 temperatures (see Q.3).
2 Seeds 42 100
3 Seeds 24 60
4 Maggots 46 90
5 Maggots 55 100
6 Maggots 30 60
126
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
®0 a In experiment 1 why did the students take more than a Plot these results on a graph, and explain the shape
one set of readings for each group of organisms? of the curve.
b Calculate the mean relative oxygen consumption for b In this investigation, identify the independent
the seeds and for the maggots. Suggest a reason (input) variable and the dependent (outcome)
for the difference. variable.
2 The students repeated the experiment with no living c Suggest any fixed variables. (Refer to page 312 if
organisms in the chamber. The coloured liquid did not you are unsure about these terms.)
move at all. Why was this important? In experiment 2:
3 In an extension of this investigation, the students 4 What is the purpose of the potassium hydroxide
measured the effect solution?
Temperature / Relative oxygen
of temperature on 5 What does the indicator solution in flask B show?
0
c consumption /
the rate of oxygen mm pers 0 How can you explain the change in flask D?
consumption by the 7 Suggest a control for this investigation, and explain
15 0.3
maggots. They why it is a suitable control.
obtained the
following results:
25 0.6
0 Suggest any visible change that might happen in
35 1.1 flask C. Explain your answer.
45 0.8
55 0.2
127
65 0.0
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
To understand why living organisms must obtain oxygen Thin (ideally one cell Gases have a short distance over which
thick) to diffuse.
from their environment, and why they must release
carbon dioxide to their environment Large surface area Many molecules of gas can diffuse across
at the same time.
■ To know the properties of an ideal gas exchange surface
Moist Cells die if not kept moist.
■ To be able to identify the parts of the human gas
Well ventilated Concentration gradients for oxygen and
exchange system carbon dioxide are kept up by regular
fresh supplies of air.
Exchanging oxygen and carbon dioxide Close to a blood supply Gases can be carried to and from the
Respiration uses oxygen to 'bum' (oxidise) food cells that need or produce them.
and so release the energy that cells need to stay Gas exchange in humans
alive. Respiration produces carbon dioxide and Like other mammals, humans are active and
water vapour as waste products: maintain a constant body temperature. This
means they use up a great deal of energy.
carbon
glucose + oxygen ➔ energy + d. .d + water
lOXl e Mammals must have a very efficient gas exchange
system.
Living organisms must be able to take oxygen from
The gas exchange system in humans is shown
the air and get rid of carbon dioxide to the air.
opposite and is made up of:
Swapping oxygen for carbon dioxide in this way is
■ a respiratory surface - membranes lining the
called gas exchange (or gaseous exchange).
alveoli (air sacs) in the lungs
Gas exchange takes place through a gas exchange ■ a set of tubes to allow air from the outside to
surface, also known as a respiratory surface. reach the respiratory surface. This set of tubes
The diagram below shows how the process has many branches, and is sometimes called
happens. The properties of an ideal respiratory the 'bronchial tree'
surface are given in the table above right. ■ a blood supply ( carried by the pulmonary
Gas exchange surface is Layer of water on artery and pulmonary vein) to carry dissolved
t hin - dissolved gases can gas exchange surface.
pass t hrough it easily.
gases to and from the respiratory surface
Carbon ■ a ventilation system (the intercostal muscles
Oxygen dioxide and the diaphragm) to keep a good flow of air
@ over the respiratory surface.
~ Ribs
~
membranes
Alveoli (air sacs) - these are lined
by the membranes where gas ~ )
~ I) Diaphragm
exchange takes place. The surface
is moist, thin and has an enormous
lj
area. (In humans, the total surface
area is about as big as a tennis court!)
I
Deoxygenated ---- - Oxygenated
blood blood
Red blood
cell
Capillary network
around alveolus
Only a thin membrane separates
the air in the alveolus from the
blood in the capillaries.
129
.
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
Vertebrae of backbone -
1. External intercostal muscles ribs pivot on these.
contract and pull the
rib cage upwards and ----ttt--\----- 3. Lung volume increases
outwards. ..,..m:-__ and the pressure falls.
Breathing
in Pleural membranes Summary:
2. Diaphragm muscles Extra lung volume created by
and pleural fluid - these
contract and diaphragm ■ rib cage moving up and out
are sticky, but also slippery
moves downwards. ■ diaphragm moving down
enough to reduce any
friction during breathing
movements.
''
pressure falls
.A The intercostal muscles ('intercostal' means 'between the ribs') and the diaphragm work together to alter the volume of the
chest cavity. Changing the volume of the chest cavity will automatically change the pressure of air inside it. (It is a law of physics
that pressure x volume is a constant- in other words, if pressure increases then volume must decrease, and vice versa.)
130
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
Air is breathed in, gas exchange happens in the therefore different from the composition of the
alveoli, and the air is breathed out again. The expired (breathed-out) air, as shown in the table.
composition of the inspired (breathed-in) air is
S T A spirogram gives a great deal of information about someone's breathing and the efficiency of their lungs. The lung
volumes are expressed in the SI unit dm 3 . 1 dm 3 is the same as 1 litre.
3
Tidal volume - the volume Vital capacity - the maximum volume of
of air breathed in and out air breathed in and out from deepest
2
"'E during one normal, resting inhalation to deepest exhalation
-....
't:J
.c
breath
"'...
QI
.c
...
QI
0
c. Time/ minutes
·="'
-0
QI
E
::::,
Breathing rate (number
0.5
131
12.2 Breathing ventilates the lungs
Factor Effect
Smoking Increase, due to the effect of carbon monoxide (see page 135).
Anxiety Increase, due to the effect of adrenaline (see page 168).
Drugs Some cause an increase, e.g. amphetamines because they are stimulants.
Some cause a decrease, e.g. alcohol and barbiturates because they are depressants (sedatives).
Environmental Increased by high C02 concentration (see page 270).
Sometimes increased by high temperature or humidity, as an attempt to lose body heat by panting (see page 146).
Altitude Increased by low 0 2 concentration in the atmosphere. Climbers at high altitude breathe quickly and with a low tidal
volume - this can cause problems of dehydration.
Weight Can increase because fat makes lung ventilation harder (i.e. tidal volume falls).
Can decrease if excess body weight is a symptom of low thyroid gland activity.
132
1 Two boys were asked to take part in an c What is the ratio of the volume of a breath
investigation into the effect of exercise on during exercise to the volume of a breath at rest?
breathing. The number of breaths they took in [2]
each half minute was measured and recorded, d Calculate the rate of breathing, in breaths
first of all while sitting still, then when recovering per minute, during strenuous exercise. [ 1]
from two minutes of hard exercise. The results are e Using the data gathered, describe two
shown in the table below. effects of exercise on breathing. [2]
f The computer could also measure the effects
Time / Activity Number of breaths
of exercise on heart rate. Suggest what these
minutes in each half minute
effects might be. [2]
Tom Alan
g What is the benefit to the body of the
0.0 7 8
effects described in e and f? [2]
0.5 7 8
2 On a visit to a sports physiology laboratory, a
1.0 Sitting still 7 8
1.5 7 8
student underwent a series of tests. He was made
2.0
to exercise on a treadmill, and the following
2.5 information was collected.
3.0 Exercise (step-ups) Heart rate / beats Total heart output I Output
3.5 per minute dm3 per minute per beat I cm3
4.0 24 24 55 4.0
4.5 23 17 70 4.8
5.0 18 13 80 5.2
5.5 15 10 90 5.6
6.0 Recovery (sitting) 12 10
120 6.0
6.5 12 9
140 6.0
7.0 10 8
150 5.8
7.5 8 8
8.0 8 8
170 4.6
8.5 7 8 a Copy the table and complete it by calculating
the output per beat for each heart rate value. [2]
a Draw a graph to show the changes in breathing h Plot a graph of total output (vertical axis) against
rate over the time period of this investigation. heart rate (horizontal axis). On the same graph
Plot both lines on the same axes. [S] plot output per beat (vertical axis) against heart
h Which boy appears to be fitter? Explain rate. [4]
your answer. [ 3] c Describe the relationship between:
The teacher of the class was interested in the i heart rate and total output [1]
changes in breathing during the exercise period. ii heart rate and output per beat. [ 1]
She used a sensor, computer interface, monitor d i Even during severe exercise, the
and printer to obtain the following information heart rate seldom rises above
on another member of the class. 140 beats per minute. Use the data
in the table to explain why this is so. [2]
Start of ii Well-trained athletes can keep up a heart
..... 3 rate of 170 beats per minute. Suggest how
E
.... their output per beat may be different from
-;;; 2
C
Cl that of an untrained person such as the
-=
.!:
student. [ 1]
... e Distance runners often have low resting heart
!0 0 rates. How might this be of advantage to
Cl.I
E
them? [2]
::II
f Increased total output means that more blood
~
2 can be delivered to active tissues. As heart rate
increases, so does breathing rate. Suggest why.[2]
3 ~~~~~~~~-~~~~~~~
0 4 8 12 16 20 24 28
Time / seconds 133
.
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
everyone should know about the possible effects links smoking with comfort or lack of stress - when
they feel stressed they may automatically reach for
of smoking. Nobody who starts smoking now can
a cigarette.
say 'But I didn't know the risks' when they suffer
the effects of their smoking habit later in life.
How is smoking harmful?
Smoking is inhaling the smoke from burning
®1 How is smoke harmf ul to the lungs?
tobacco (and paper). This smoke can harm the 2 What is t he difference between physical and
lungs and respiratory passages for a number of psychological addiction? How can smokers be helped
reasons: to overcome their addiction?
■ it is hot 3 Suggest three harmful effects of smoking other than
■ it has a drying effect
damage to the lungs and breath ing passages.
■ it contains many harmful chemicals.
4 Why are smokers more likely to develop infections of
The heat and dryness irritate the lungs, but the lungs than non-smokers?
the main dangers of smoking come from the 0 Draw a single cube with a side of 10 cm, and then
chemicals in the burning tobacco. There are over the same cube divided into smal ler cubes each w ith a
1000 known chemicals in tobacco smoke. These side of 1 cm.
include tars, carbon monoxide, sulfur dioxide, a How many small cubes fit into the large cube?
nicotine and even small quantities of arsenic and b What is the surface area of each small cube?
plutonium! When doctors treat lung diseases c What is the total surface area of al l of the smal l
with medicine, the molecules of the medicine cubes?
are delivered in a spray; the droplets of water in d What is the surface area of the large cube?
the spray carry the medicine down through the e Use your answers to explain why emphysema
respiratory tubes and deep into the lungs. Burning sufferers are often very breathless.
134
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
-------,
Larynx (voice box} - air passes s Cilia - fine 'hairs' on
through here during breathing. When surface of cell. These
breathing out, the vocal cords can be can beat in a
made to vibrate. The sounds produced Nucleus
- coordinated way to
create our speech. carry mucus (with
Basement
membrane-
trapped microbes
and dust) away from
holds the cells
in place the lung surfaces.
~ Ribs
u
ventilation
~ muscles i (see page 130)
~ Pleural
I
Deoxygenated ..........- - Oxygenated
blood blood
gen
uses into Carbon dioxide
blood diffuses out of Red blood
blood plasma. cell
Capillary network
around alveolus
Only a thin membrane separates
the air in the alveolus from the
blood in the capillaries.
135
.
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
..
"' Q.
:::,
Key O Boys D Girls
Ill 0
30
Sir Richard Doll's research into .:K ..
O Cl
smoking
We know today that smoking causes disease, but
-
E
"' Cl
0
Ill
Cl~
Ill
"'
..
Ill
20
10
.19,...
c.-
how have we found this out? The diseases could ~ J,
t-
result from living in a polluted environment, or a.·= 2000 2005 2010 2015
Year
exposure to chemicals at work, or diet, or any
Cigarette sales in the UK have fallen because people
number of other factors.
are becoming more aware of the health risks of smoking.
Sir Richard Doll was an epidemiologist - he studied Advertising campaigns emphasise the dangers, and
patterns in the distribution of diseases. He was smoking is banned in many public places to reduce
particularly interested in comparing the habits and 'passive smoking' (breathing in someone else's cigarette
smoke). Tobacco companies are focusing on selling to
environment of people who developed lung disease
developing countries where people are less aware of
with people who did not. His results were very
the health risks. The rise in lung disease in the UK
valuable because he collected data in a scientific in the 1980s and 1990s was repeated 20 years later in
way, removing many variables from his studies. these countries.
For example: The number of cigarettes sold in the UK and in Mexico,
■ he carried out many of his studies on doctors, 1960-1995.
so he could rule out profession as a cause of 250
C
lung disease .!:! - 200
■ he separated data for people living in cities
a.E >'ii
5l ; 150
from those living in the countryside, so C \D
Cl
C:
..-===::..:::: an important cause of lung disease
and death, then early death would be more
-=E x25 likely in smokers tha n in non-smokers
~
...0
...
~
l'CI
x20
QI
"Cl
~ x15
0
~
Ill
·;:: x10 A correlation between two variables does not
C:
necessarily prove that one of the variables
QI
Ill causes the other - it might be that heavy
l'CI x5
...
QI
1,1
smokers develop lung cancer because they
C: 1 are exposed to some other environmental
0 factor, or that individuals w ith a genetic
0 10 20 30 40
make-up that carries a risk of lung cancer
Cigarettes smoked per day are also 'genetically' more likely to smoke.
The work of Richard Doll and others is so
convincing because it has eliminated many
11'1 100 ...... ...... other environmental factors. However, it is
11'1
QI
... ... ...... likely that the development of lung cancer
Cl 90 ... ... is a complex process. It is probably
...
l'CI ... ... multifactorial, involving both genetic and
80
l'CI
'' lifestyle factors.
QI
-~ 70
''
...
l'CI ''
QI 60 ''
.c
E
' ' ,,smokers
::I 50
C: ''
~
0 40 ''
''
--~
'#.
QI
30 ''
''
''
Results of a retrospective study -
looking back at t he lifestyle, occupation
iii
...0
20 •
I ' ' ......
'
and environment of people who have died
......... ... __
Ill
from lung ca ncer
t
10 •
0
C 0
55 60 65 70 75 80 85 90 95
Age / years
.A. In 1962, the Royal College of Physicians published a report on smoking and health, which suggested a clear link
between cancer and smoking. For example, among a sample of doctors living in similar-sized cities, those who smoked
regularly were more likely to develop cancer of the lung.
137
Questions on respiration and gas
exchange
1 Copy the following paragraph and complete it by follows, and then placed into sterilised vacuum
filling in the missing words. flasks.
Use words from the following list. Each word
may be used once, more than once or not at all.
oxygen, carbon dioxide, pulmonary, energy, Vacuum flask
hydrogencarbonate, thin, capillaries, alveoli,
diffusion, respiring, left atrium, surface area
Deoxygenated blood arrives at the lungs in the
artery. Oxygen has been removed from the
blood by cells that are ___ to release _ __
needed to carry out their functions. This blood Germinating peas
also contains a relatively high concentration of
the gas - -, which is carried dissolved in the
plasma as ions. Each artery branches
many times to form _ , which are well
adapted to allow the exchange of gases because Cotton wool - - -~ 1
they are _ _ -walled and have a very large 11----- Thermometer
- - -· These small vessels lie very close to
the of the lungs, and it is here that gas
exchange takes place. The gas ___ moves out • Sample 1 was soaked in water at 15°C for
of the blood and the gas _ _ moves into the 24 hours and then placed in flask A.
blood. Both gases move by the process of _ _ • Sample 2 was soaked in water at 15°C for
Oxygenated blood then leaves the lungs in the 24 hours, boiled, cooled again to 15°C and
_ _ vein that returns blood to the heart at the then placed in flask B.
chamber called the _ _ [10] • Sample 3 was soaked in water at 15°C for
2 The table below provides information about the 24 hours, washed with a mild disinfectant and
composition of inhaled and exhaled air. then placed in flask C.
The thermometer was used to measure the
Air breathed in Air breathed out temperature in each of the flasks over a period
(inhaled air) (exhaled air)
of 72 hours. The results are shown in the table
Nitrogen 79.0% 79.0% below.
Oxygen 20.97% 16.9%
Time/ h Flask A/ °C Flask B / °C Flask C / °C
Carbon dioxide 0.03% 4.1% 0 (start of 15 15 15
Water vapour variable saturated experiment)
12 25 15 18
a State which sample contains the most oxygen. 24 40 15 22
Explain why. [2] 36 48 15 25
b Explain the results for the percentage of 48 50 15 28
nitrogen gas. [1] 60 52 15 32
c Name the process which results in the 72 54 15 38
changes in the percentage of carbon dioxide.
[1] a On the same axes, plot a graph of the three
d Suggest why the percentage of water vapour sets of results. [S]
in inhaled air varies. [1] b Name the process that caused the rise in
3 The apparatus shown was used to investigate temperature in flasks A and C. [1]
whether living organisms release heat energy. c Suggest why the pea seeds were soaked before
Some pea seeds were divided into three samples being placed in the flasks. [2]
of equal mass. The samples were treated as d Explain the results for flask B. [2]
138
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
e Explain the difference between the results for The photographs below show normal lung
flasks A and C. [2] tissue and lung tissue from a person with
f Suggest a reason for the inclusion of flask B.[l] emphysema.
4 These diagrams show apparatus that can be i Describe two differences between the
used to explain the mechanism of breathing. normal lung tissue and the lung tissue from
. - - - -Air goes in and out here a person with emphysema. [2]
ii How will these differences affect the supply
of oxygen to the blood in the person with
Glass tube
~ 'Tra chea'
emphysema? [2]
d
II 'Bronchus'
Balloon 'Lung'
Glass
wall 'Chest wall'
ofa - -
bell jar J.J - ----
-Pulled down '
~ 1
Rubber__}
sheet
Diagram A J 2
3
Normal lung tissue (x40). Lung tissue from a person
with emphysema (x40).
Look at diagram B.
[1] Liquid paraffin _ __
_..
Adrenal artery and vein _ _ _ __...;_ _ _ _____.M ..-- - - - : -- Cortex - contains glomeru li which filter excess
flu id and waste products out of the blood
Renal artery- contains blood - - -----;.-__.:-._;
w ith high urea concentration - - - Medulla - contains long regions of kidney
Right kidney - - - - - - - --l--___:!111-.,, tubules wh ich can vary the amount
and composition of the urine
Renal vein - contains blood _ _ __...;;___ ___,
w ith lower urea concentration
A The kidneys receive blood from the renal artery, remove urea and a variable amount of water from it and
return the 'modified' blood to the circulation through the renal vein. The wastes removed from the blood are
140
eventually expelled from the body through the urethra after being stored in the bladder.
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
The structure of the kidney The functional unit - the kidney tubule
The kidneys a nd their blood vessels are located in (nephron)
th e abdomen, as shown in the diagram opposite. Each kidney contains hundreds of thousands of
The kidneys constantly produce urine which then long tubes called nephrons, each with its own
p asses to th e bladder. bran ch of the ren al artery and vein. Each nephron
works in exactly th e sa me way, so the function of
'Y The kidney is made up of many nephrons (kidney
tubules). Substances are filtered out of the blood into the th e kidney can be explained by considering the
nephron. Useful molecules and most of the water are working of just one of these kidney tubules, as
S reabsorbed into the blood. shown below.
Key
• water
• waste
• useful molecules
® 1 Define the terms excretion and osmoregulation. receives materials from the blood after filtration in the
E) Name two waste products of metabolism. State their capsule. The tubules then remove useful
source and how they are removed from the blood. substances such as _ _ from this filtrate by the process
3 Copy and complete the following paragraph. of _ __The remaining waste or excess materials pass
The main excretory organ in the mammal is the - -· down the tubule and leave the excretory organ via the
There are two of these, each supplied with blood _ _ They are collected for temporary storage in the
through the _ _ and each composed of many _ _ Eventually a dilute solution of these wastes, the
thousands of tubules called - -· Each of these tubules urine, leaves the body through the - -·
141
.
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
s OBJECTIVES
■ To explain how body water is regulated
Kidney failure
Damage to the kidneys, perhaps through infection
■ To explain how kidney disease can be treated
or following an accident, can stop the nephrons
working efficiently. The body can no longer
Osmoregulation control the composition or amount of urine
The final part of each nephron, the collecting formed, so the content of the blood plasma and
duct, removes water from the filtered solution tissue fluid is not kept at its optimum. Death may
passing down inside the tubule and returns it to follow quite quickly if the kidney failure is not
the blood. The body can control the amount of corrected. Two types of treatment are available:
water that is returned to the blood in this way, ■ dialysis using a kidney machine (an artificial
and balance it with the amount of water taken kidney)
in in the diet and the amount of water lost from ■ kidney transplant.
the body by other means. This vital control of
water balance is called osmoregulation. Water Dialysis and the artificial kidney
A kidney machine takes a patient's blood, 'cleans'
is the most common substance in the body, and
has many functions (see page 256). The average it and returns the blood to the circulation.
This process is called dialysis. Wastes diffuse
daily intake and loss of water by different
out of the blood, across a partially permeable
methods is outlined in the diagram below.
membrane, into a fluid that is constantly renewed.
In this way urea is removed from the blood
without altering any of its other features. The
diagram on the opposite page shows the workings
of a kidney dialysis machine.
n
but fat. Water is released of water
3
Drinks 1500 cm 1500 cm 3
when the fat is respired.
Water in foods 800 cm 3 Sweat 500 cm 3
From 200 cm 3 1 5 dm3 in 25 dm3 Exhaled air 400 cm 3
respiration tissue fluid inside Faeces 100 cm 3
and blood the cells
plasma
142 ~ The water excreted in the urine is adjusted so that total water intake and total water loss are balanced
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
! Overall, dialysis:
■ maintains blood glucose concentration
■ balances salt intake and removal
Blood taken from - - - - 11 ■ removes urea from the blood.
artery - leaves body
under high pressure.
Kidney transplants
A kidney transplant involves surgically ® 1 The body must maintain a water balance.
transferring a healthy kidney from one person
a Why does the body need water?
(the donor) to a person with kidney failure (the b How is water gained by the body?
recipient). It is relatively simple to connect c How is water lost by the body?
up the donor kidney in the recipient's body, but E) The water balance of the body is maintained by
a problem arises with tissue rejection. The negative feedback. Explain what this term means.
recipient's immune system will attack the donor 3 Why is a kidney transplant considered better than
kidney and slowly destroy it (see page 119) dialysis? What problems are associated with kidney
unless the recipient takes drugs to stop this transplantation?
happening. Blood groups and tissue types of
donors and recipients are carefully matched to
reduce the likelihood of rejection. Successful
kidney transplants have advantages over dialysis
treatment:
■ In the long term, a transplant is much cheaper.
■ The patient's life is less disrupted once they
have recovered from the operation.
143
.
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
Lungs regulate
tissue fluid) are maintained at an optimum - _ _ _ ____. exchange of carbon
the best values for the cells to function. The dioxide and oxygen.
maintenance of a constant internal environment ) ' ~1
is called homeostasis. ~ + - - - - Intestines supply
Liver regulates soluble foods and
Homeostasis involves several organs, but the basic the levels of many water.
solutes in the blood,
principle is always the same, as shown below. The and removes poisons (see page 81 ).
diagram on the right shows some of the organs
A Many organs play a part in homeostasis. (A more accurate
involved in homeostasis, and the particular
diagram of the human circulation is given on page 100.)
conditions in the tissue fluid which they regulate.
Homeostatic
External systems even out
environment has variations in the
Varying conditions conditions
many factors which
may be experienced
can vary greatly, e.g. experienced by
by the body. the body, e.g.
amount of food
available. the liver can store
or release glucose.
-
.!!!
'ii
0
>
.....CU
This is the range of
this factor that can
be controlled by _ _----1
Control centre sets off
homeostasis. Cells
the correct responses.
work well within
this range.
A. In homeostasis, deviation from a set point acts as the signal that sets off the correction mechanism .
This negative feedback keeps variable factors within the narrow range suitable for life.
® 1 Copy and complete the following paragraph. Homeostatic organ Factor controlled
Cells work best when conditions around them remain Liver
constant. Cells are bathed in _ _ fluid, and many
systems work to keep the composition of this fluid Lungs
constant. Each system has - -, which detect any Water content of blood
changes from the _ _ (the ideal conditions for the Heat loss or gain
cells). The changes are then communicated to the
- -, usually along _ _ neurones. The central Intestines
control area then sets off the correct responses. These 0 Use the principle of feedback control to compare
responses cancel out the original change and so this the regulation of blood glucose level in humans
sort of control is often called - -· (see page 148) with the maintenance of a stable
temperature in an aircraft cabin.
2 Copy and complete the following table.
145
.
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
~ Integrator
Detector in brain ---......
/ Corrective mecharisms:
Increase attempt to incease
heat loss
__!_____
Norm
....JI The optimum
temperature for
\
Norm
the body's activities
- - - - - - -....[ is about 37°C ,..., --------.1
\ Corrective median!..,:
Decrease attempt to
conserve heat ... .......
Detector - - Integrator ~
in brain Subcutaneous ('under the skin') Capillary beds
fat insulates against heat loss - Sensory neurone carries
only involved in long-term impulses to the hypothalamus
(e.g. seasonal) temperature in the brain
control
Dermis ········································:
Sweat gland - produces sweat
Pancreas produces
Liver converts more of the
glucose hormone
➔ glycogen insulin
Too high
= hyperglycaemia
Too low
= hypoglycaemia
Pancreas produces
Liver converts more of the
glycogen hormone
➔ glucose glucagon
• Blood glucose level is under feedback control by the hormones insulin and glucagon
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
e .i
- cataract formation
- hardening of arteries
- heart disease .
■ Treatment is by regular injection of pure
Cells can carry out work
insulin - much of this is now manufactured
by genetic engineering (see page 292).
■ A diet that contains too much fat and
too much sugar can also cause a form of
diabetes. This Type II diabetes can be
Clinistix are thin strips of plastic controlled by adjusting the diet to limit
with a small pad at the bottom. fat and sugar, and does not need injection
The pad contains an enzyme and of insulin. This 'non-insulin-dependent'
a dye. If glucose is present, the
diabetes is a common problem for obese
enzyme uses it to change the
people.
colour of the dye. A Clinistix
dipped into a urine sample from
a diabetic person will give a positive @
result within seconds. Clinistix ar 1 This list contains a number of statements about
an excellent example of the medical diabetes. Complete the statements by matching
uses of enzymes (see page 294). a letter from the with a number.
149
Questions on excretion and homeostasis
1 a What is hypothermia? [1] h Sometimes a transplanted kidney is rejected.
h Why are old people particularly at risk Explain why rejection may occur. [2]
from hypothermia? [1] c Below is a record of how much urine a
c Why do you think children lose heat healthy man produced each day during one
very quickly? [1] week. The man's diet included the same
2 This diagram shows how body temperature amount of water each day.
is controlled.
Day Volume of urine produced / cm3
Body Sweating, Body Monday 1540
t emperature rises Sensor in ____. dilation temperature falls
Tuesday 1470
brain of blood
vessels in skin
' Wednesday 1510
Normal body Normal body
Thursday 1240
temperature temperature Friday 1450
Saturday 1770
Shivering,
~
Sensor in ____. constriction Sunday 1520
Body brain of blood Body
temperature falls vessels in skin temperature rises i Calculate the average (mean) volume of
urine produced each day. [2]
a Use this information to explain how humans ii Suggest, with reasons, why the amount
control body temperature. [4] of urine produced was quite different on
h Explain how shivering affects body two of the days. [2]
temperature. [1] 4 A person who suffers kidney failure may be
c How does the liver contribute to body treated every few days by dialysis. This uses an
heat? [2] artificial kidney machine. The diagram shows
d Use the diagram to explain the meaning of the working of a kidney machine. In this
'negative feedback'. [2] machine a special solution flows around the
3 If a person's kidneys are diseased he or she may outside of an inner tube which carries the
have a kidney transplant. The transplanted kidney patient's blood.
is connected to blood vessels which go into and out Special solution of glucose, salts and am ino acids
of the leg. at the concentration found in normal blood
a Copy and complete the diagram on the next ll
page to show clearly how the artery, vein and
tube carrying urine should be connected in a Blood to
patient's ~
_j '=:_____________________~---l
_
_..,_____
Blood from
~ patient's
transplant operation. [2] vein •• • ----- - ···-····--·-····- ··-····" ( artery
\..__ --- ~~
Artery
I
Partially permeable Special solution +
membranes excess wastes from
the blood
151
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
A B C D
Cotton
wool
152
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
4500
t;
~ 4000
C
:-e
-
Ill
3500
==
0
CU
3000
-
N
·;;;
.l!l 2500
C
Ill
c.
"'
C 2000
......
-...
Ill
0 1500
CU
.c
E 1000
::II
z
500
Key
D transplants - wait ing list
153
.
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
distances. \ \
Nerve impulses
'\
'\''
''
'' \
neurone, to a muscle cell or to a gland cell. A. A nerve is made of many neurones. This motor neurone
S The end of the neurone is separated from carries information from the CNS to an effector.
the next cell by a tiny gap, visible under a
microscope, and the impulses can only cross
this gap in one direction. This gap, called a
synapse, acts like a valve as explained in the
diagram below.
End of one The synapse is the junction
neurone between the end plate of
one neurone and the
dendrite of the next.
1 An impulse arrives at
the synapse.
2 At the end plate are
tiny vesicles containing
a chemical
Cell body of (neurotransmitter).
next neurone 3 The chemical is released
into the gap.
E 4 The chemical diffuses
Many drugs, such as heroin,
have their effects by changing across the gap and the
the way neurotransmitters impulse restarts on the
diffuse across this gap. other side when the
Often the effects depend neurotransmitter binds to
on the relative shapes of the correct receptor
the drug and the molecule.
neurotransmitter, and how
they 'fit' the receptor.
A. Impulses travel along a neurone in the direction that
allows the mammal to respond to changes in its environment.
They can only pass across the synapse in this direction.
®0 Suggest two similarities and two differences 3 Explain the difference between:
between the endocrine system and the nervous a motor and sensory neurones
system. What is the importance of these b central and peripheral nervous systems.
differences? 4 How does a nerve impulse:
2 Explain how the structure of a neurone is related to a pass along a neurone
its function. b cross a synapse? 155
.
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
156
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
Spinal
nerve- has
both sensory
and motor neurones,
so carries impulses
into and out
of the CNS.
Galen, a surgeon who worked
w ith the gladiators of Rome,
dicovered that each spinal
nerve had two branches.
Gladiators wounded in the
back often lost the power of
sensation but could still move,
Direction whereas those wounded on
of impulse the front could not move
although they could still
1 Receptor - a cell or an organ
feel pain.
that receives a stimulus and Ventral ('belly')
converts it into an branch of
electrical impulse. spinal nerve
4 Motor neurone
- carries impulse
from the CNS to 3 Connector or relay neurone
the effector. - carries impulse slowly across
the spinal cord. No myelin sheath:
this gives t ime for the action to
Cell body at one end of the cell. be modified by impulses carried
Has myelin sheath. down the spinal cord from the brain.
157
.
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
....___...._
include breathing, heartbeat and
peristalsis .
e.g skin
In simple terms:
159
.
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
• All receptors work in the same way- they convert one form of energy (the stimulus) into another form that
160 the nervous system can understand
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
The body also has a sense of position. Each muscle and tendon sends information about The diagram below shows
how stretched it is to the central nervous system (CNS). The CNS interprets this so that we the arrangement of the
'know' where each part of the body is in relation to the other parts (see how easy it is to
structures in the eye.
_J
■ Light needs to be refracted (bent) less. ■ Light must be greatly refracted (bent).
be more powerful. The ability
■ Ciliary muscles relax, eyeball ■ Ciliary muscles contract, pull eyeball
of the lens system to produce becomes spherical. inwards (eyeball 'bulges' forward).
a sharp image of objects at ■ Ligaments are tight. ■ Ligaments relax .
different distances is called ■ Lens is pulled long and thin. ■ Lens becomes short and fat.
accommodation. As people
get older the lens becomes less Relaxed or waking eyes are set for Eyestrain is caused by long periods
elastic and loses its ability to viewing distant objects so that images of close work. The ciliary muscles are
change shape. This makes it of close objects (such as alarm clocks!) contracting against the pressure of fluid
are blurred . in the eyeball.
harder to refocus quickly on
objects at different distances.
Smokers may experience this
problem earlier than non-smokers because smoke 'ages' molecules in the lens.
162
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
s The iris controls the light intensity at that the rod and cone receptor cells are not over-
the retina stimulated. If too much light fell on them they
Light falls on the retina and stimulates the rods would not recover in time to allow continued clear
and cones to produce nerve impulses. These travel vision. The iris contains muscles that alter the size
to the brain along the optic nerve. It is important of the pupil, thereby controlling the amount of light
that falls on the retina. This control is automatic,
Stimulus - light fal ls on retina and is a good example of a reflex action. This pupil
reflex is explained in this diagram.
I
Impulses in motor neurones
I
if
@
Low light intensity - High light intensity -
radial muscles of iris contract
and the pupil is
opened w idet so . reduced in size,
@·_
circular muscles of iris contract
and the pupi l is
(4 ''; ~
more light can Radial so less light can '~ '
muscles . ---·
enter and reach enter and the retina
~ e retina. The muscles of the iris is protected from bleaching.
.~-.. . 19!~
...
~
--
\@0,
·. l_
Adrenaline (see page 168) Heroin imitates this part of the ◄ The pupil reflex prevents bleach ing
imitates this part of the reflex - pupils constrict.
of the retina by regulating the
reflex - pupils dilate.
amount of light that enters the eye
The retina contains two types of light-sensitive cell, rods and cones, as shown in the diagram below.
Rod cells are packed most tightly around Rods provide black-and-white images. Several rods
the edge of the retina. Objects are seen / may be 'wired' to a single sensory neurone in the
most clearly at night by not looking / optic nerve, giving great sensitivity at low light
directly at them. ' intensity (night vision), but images lack detail.
,,
, - Layer of pigment prevents
internal reflection which
/ sensory
neurone ~( might lead to multiple or
to optic I'--( blurred images. This is the
nerve 'black' you can see
through the pupil.
\.
A
Light rays from an object are refracted by the
and the which focus the light rays
onto the . The amount of light that reaches
this light-sensitive layer is controlled by the __
--===~~I~~ ~~~
Cut ventral root
which is able to adjust the size of the __ (the
black 'hole' in the front of the eye). There are two Biceps muscle _ _
types of light-sensitive cells, the - -, which are
responsible for __ vision in low light intensity,
and the , which are responsible for i
vision in __ light intensity. The image formed on I
the __ is __ and __ than the object, but the
nerve impulses that pass along the __ nerve to
the brain are interpreted so that they make sense.
The ability of the brain to compare incoming
information with previous experience, and to set
off the correct response, is called - -· [ 6]
a Name the type of neurone labelled A. What
4 A group of students suggested that coffee is important function does it have? [2]
enjoyable because it speeds up the heart rate. h Name the gap labelled B. [1]
They gave several groups of people different c In what form is a message transmitted:
amounts of coffee one morning and collected the i along a nerve fibre [1]
following information. ii across the gap B? [1]
Number of cups Heart rate / beats per minute d Give two examples of spinal reflexes, two of
of coffee drunk Total Mean cranial reflexes and one conditioned reflex. [S]
0 74, 76, 72, 72, 78,68 e How would sensation in the limb be affected
g Name the parts C-G on the diagram of a ii For this purpose, name the stimulus,
sensory neurone below. State two ways in receptor, coordinator and effector. Copy
which this neurone differs from a motor and complete the diagram below. [2]
neurone. [7]
DL--JIHL--JD
I
Represents
I r Stimulus Receptor Coordinator
Pancreas
■ Insulin and glucagon - control of
blood sugar concentration
(see page 148).
s Level increases if
endocrine gland
Increased Detected by Less hormone
secreted, so level
hormone level cells of the
secretes too much . acts as a 'signal' . endocrine glands. in blood falls.
Adrenaline
One hormone that has been widely studied is
Adrenaline is known as the 'flight or fight' hormone,
0
adrenaline. This substance seems to bridge released when the body is given a shock.
the gap between nervous and endocrine The overall effect is to provide more glucose and more
control. It is definitely a chemical messenger, oxygen for working muscles - preparation for action!
and is released directly into the bloodstream,
yet its actions are often very rapid indeed
and may only last for a very short time. The
widespread and instant effects of adrenaline
are described below.
BUT BEWARE!
■ Drug abuse is illegal and can lead to lengthy
bans for sportsmen and women.
■ 'Artificial' hormones can switch off natural .A Liu Chunhong was stripped of her gold medal in the
hormone production by feedback inhibition. 69 kg weightlifting class at the 2008 Olympic Games.
Men may lose their sexual potency, gain body
Samples of urine and blood re-tested four years later led to
fat and develop 'squeaky' voices, and women
Liu and two other female weightlifters losing their medals
may cease menstruation and ovulation (and
and facing two-year bans from competition.
sometimes develop excessive body hair).
168
1 The table below lists some of the effects of 4 Normal blood glucose level is 1 mg per cm3 •
hormones . Ten people with normal blood glucose levels
Match each hormone with its effect. Write the were tested for blood glucose and plasma
letter and number to show your answer, for insulin levels over a period of six hours. The
example, a- 4. mean values for these measurements were
calculated and recorded. The test period
Hormone Effect
included two meals and a session of exercise.
a adrenaline 1 development of sperm The results are shown in the table below.
b insulin 2 secreted if blood glucose level falls
c testosterone 3 increase in heart rate Time/ Activity Blood glucose Plasma insulin
hours level / mg level / 1,1g
d oestrogen 4 produced by the pancreas as blood
per cm 3 per cm 3
glucose level increases
0 Meal eaten 1.0 10
e glucagon 5 deposition of fat in the breasts
0.5 1.5 20
2 A dangerously aggressive animal is unlikely 1.0 1.0 40
to fit into society. Aggression may be an 1.5 0.8 25
important part of puberty in male animals, 2.0 Exercise started 0.8 15
and may help to win females. Explain how 2.5 Exercise finished 1.2 10
negative feedback (feedback control) would 3.0 1.0 20
keep aggression within acceptable limits in a 3.5 1.0 10
young male animal. [ 4]
4.0 Meal eaten 1.0 10
3 Copy and complete the following paragraph.
4.5 1.4 20
Use words from the following list. Each word
5.0 1.0 35
may be used once, more than once or not at all.
5.5 0.8 40
starch, glucose, insulin, oxygen, deep, 6.0 0.8 10
intestines, muscles, pales, dilate, glycogen,
stands upright, flight, fight, adrenaline, rapid a Present all the data in the form of
a graph. [4]
A human exposed to a severe shock responds
h What effect does the period of exercise have
by producing the hormone - -· This hormone
on the blood glucose and plasma insulin
causes the storage polysaccharide __ to
levels? Explain your answer. [2]
be converted to - -, a soluble sugar used
c Suggest two other hormones that would
to release energy via respiration. Aerobic
change in concentration in the blood
respiration requires __ as well as this sugar,
during exercise. Why are these hormones
and more of this gas is made available because
important? [2]
the hormone causes __ and __ breathing.
d Why is it good experimental technique to:
The body makes the most of its resources by
i take mean values for blood glucose and
adjusting blood flow to different organs - less
plasma insulin levels [2]
blood flows to the - -, for example, and more
ii use only subjects with normal glucose
flows to the - -• The face of a shocked person
levels? [1]
shows three effects of this hormone - the
e How long after a meal does it take for the
skin , the pupils and the hair
blood glucose level to return to normal? [1]
Because of these effects this hormone is often
called the __ or __ hormone. [ 6]
169
.
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
,,, ,,
Shoot grows and Shoot w it h tip Cut t ip replaced on agar Shoot marked Shoot bends towards
bends towards light removed : less Gelly). Shoot grows and w ith harmless ink light: ink marks show
growth and no bend ing bends towards light region of growth
towards light
170
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
Gap to allow B
entry of light
Procedure
A B C
Young shoot
1 Freshly germinated broad
bean seedlings are fixed in
position inside a glass jar.
Young root
---r-
Bean seedling held
between blotting
paper and wall
A
------------
B
- C 2 Seedlings are allowed to grow
for a further 5 days, with
the jars placed as shown in
of glass jar f A, Band C.
Roll of moist
blotting paper Root turns to grow downwards,
shoot turns to grow upwards.
Plant hormones have commercial uses plants are at the base of all huma n food chains.
Humans put th eir knowledge of how hormones Some examples of the commercial use of pla nt
work in plants to good use. Being able to hormones are illustrated above and in th e
control th e growth of plants is valuable, because diagram below.
® Copy and complete the following paragraphs. E) Plant hormones have many commercial uses.
1 The _ _ of a growing shoot produces a plant These include:
hormone or - -· This substance causes cells behind ■ the stimulation of _ _ on cuttings, which allows
the tip to _ by the absorption of _ . When the growers to produce many _ of valuable plants
shoot is lit from one side, more _ _ accumulates on ■ the control of - -, which allows growers to
the dark side. As a result the cells _ _ more and the harvest economically with machinery
shoot bends towards the light. This response is called ■ the destruction of _ _ , which could otherwise
_ _ and offers several advantages to the plant, compete with crops for - -, _ _ and - -·
including greater access to light energy to drive the Careful selection of hormone concentrations allows
process of - -· this destruction to be _ _: only pest plants are killed.
■ the production of _ _ fruits because the hormone
can make the plant develop a fruit without _ _
taking place.
173
• ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
A fungus such as Penicillium absorbs food treat viral diseases, such as influenza or the
molecules from its environment, and then common cold.
uses these molecules for its own metabolism. Production of penicillin
Sometimes a Penicillium mould will make
s The large-scale production of penicillin takes
substances that it secretes into its environment place in industrial fermenters. Penicillin is a
to kill off any disease-causing or competitive secondary metabolic product - it is made
microorganisms. A product made by one when growth of the producer organism is
microorganism to kill off another microorganism slowing down rather than when it is at its
is called an antibiotic. maximum, as shown in the diagram below.
-C
::,
0
C
0
Filtered liquid
contains penicillin.
.::
-"'...
C
QI
V
C
Keep sterile!
■ no microbes to
compete for nutrients
Penicillin
0
u ■ no danger of toxic
0 2 3 4 5 6
Time/ days
174
ORGANISATION AND MAINTENANCE OF ORGANISMS
Antibiotic resistance
As the use of antibiotics increases, strains of
bacteria that are resistant to the antibodies are C
• • • • • • • • • •
■ The antibiotic is the
• • • • • • • • • • selection pressure
• • • • • • • • • • (see page 234).
■ Resistance is the
• • • • L__ c== ~ • • • • •
Antibiotic
survival advantage.
Cell division • • • • •
• • • • • treatment
NB The antibiotic does
• • • • • • • • • • not create the resistance,
but selects it in a population.
• • • • • • • • • •
Mutation (see page 230) Only resistant Whole population
results in one resistant cell cell survives. is now resistant.
in normal population.
~ Antibiotic-resistant strains of bacteria are formed by artificial selection. This is more likely to happen if:
■ antibiotics are used unnecessarily
■ people do not finish a course of prescribed antibiotics.
This allows some of the bacterial population to recover, and possibly develop strains that are resistant to the antibiotic.
®0 Distinguish clearly between the following pairs of O Purified penicillin is normally taken orally (by
terms: mouth). The crystals of the drug are enclosed in a
a antiseptic and antibiotic capsule for distribution. Suggest three important
b antibiotic and antibody properties of the material used to make the
c resistance and immunity. capsules.
175
. DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
Reproduction: a summary
Living organisms can pass on their characteristics to the next
generation (reproduce) in two ways.
Sexual reproduction: offspring and to the parents.
■ requires two organisms of the same species, Asexual reproduction:
one male and one female ■ involves only one parent organism
■ each individual produces sex cells (gametes) ■ all the characteristics of this one parent are
■ sexual reproduction always involves passed on to all of the offspring
fertilisation - the fusion of the gametes to ■ asexual reproduction produces genetically
produce a zygote identical offspring from one parent
■ offspring receives some genes from each ■ many organisms reproduce asexually when
parent, so shows a mixture of parental conditions are favourable (e.g. when there is
characteristics plenty of food), and build up their numbers
■ each of the offspring is different to other quickly.
0 Diploid (2n)
cell in testis 0 Diploid (2n)
cell in ovary
Diploid (2n)
parent cell
Gn
Meiosis Meiosis Mi osis
0 0 0 0 Haploid (n)
gametes
Offspring 0 0
Mitosis Mitosis
Fertil tion
Advantage Disadvantage
177
OBJECTIVES
1 The young plant develops reproductive organs.
■ To understand the part played by flowers in the
2 Sex cells (gametes) develop inside the
life of a flowering plant
reproductive organs.
■ To be able to identify the parts of a typical flower
3 The male sex cells are transferred to the female
■ To be able to state the functions of the parts of a flower
sex cells.
4 Fusion of male and female sex cells
An individual plant, like any other living
(fertilisation) occurs, and a zygote is produced.
organism, eventually dies. For a species of plant
5 The zygote develops into an embryo.
to survive, the individual plants must be able
6 The embryo grows into a new young plant, and
to replace themselves. This is the process of
the cycle starts all over again.
reproduction, an essential part of the life cycle
of the plant. Whereas animals move around freely (they are
motile), plants live in a fixed position. So, in plants:
Sexual reproduction in plants
■ Male gametes may have to be carried some
Flowering plants, as their name suggests,
distance to meet female gametes.
are able to reproduce using highly adapted
■ Young plant embryos may have to be carried
structures called flowers. The life cycle of a
some distance to get away from their parents!
flowering plant is outlined below.
Flowering plants reproduce sexually. Most plants are hermaphrodite, that is, they
The following list shows the stages that have male and female sexual parts on the same
can be recognised in the reproduction of individual. This means that the male gametes only
flowering plants. have to travel a short distance to the female gametes.
The young plant matures, Inside the flower, male and female
and under the correct light gametes develop. Pollination occurs
and temperature conditions when male gametes are transferred to
produces flowers. the female part of the flower.
\ I
\
move the seed away from the
'agent' carries it away from parent plant.
the parent.
Male gametes fuse
with female gametes
at fertilisation. This
Under the correct conditions occurs in the female
the seed germinates to part of the flower.
produce a young plant.
.A.. The structure of a flower: the convolvulus (morning glory). A f lower grows from a f lower
bud and is specialised to produce and release the male and female gametes.
® 1 Look at the table on the right. M atch each part of a Flower parts Functions
flower to its function . Write the letter and number
a pollen 1 to support the anther
to show your answer, for example, a-5.
0 Copy and complete the following paragraph.
b flower stalk 2 to secrete a sugary solution
The life cycle of a flowering plant has a number of c style 3 to contain the fema le gametes
stages. A young plant develops when a seed d filament 4 to protect the flower in bud
The plant matures until it produces a which is e anther 5 to deliver the male gamete
a collection of leaves specialised for . Male f sepal 6 to form a base for the flower
gametes are transferred to the female part of the g petal 7 to hold up the stigma
flower by and fuse with female gametes at
h nectary 8 to attract insects
. Following this process the ovary develops into
ovary 9 to produce pollen
a which contains a and a structure to
help move it away from the parent plant. This
j stigma 10 to receive pollen
process, which is called , requires some agent
or vector to remove the seed from the parent plant.
179
.
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
. :
s
Pollination
s Self-pollination and cross-pollination In self-pollination, pollen is transferred from anther to stigma of the
For sexual reproduction to occur, the male same plant. This is very efficient (the pollen doesn't have to travel
very far) but does not offer much chance of genetic variation (see
gametes must be transferred to the female part page 230).
of the flower - this transfer is the process of
pollination. The transfer may come about within
the same flower (self-pollination) or from one
flower to another of the same species (cross-
pollination), as shown in the diagram on the right.
Cross-pollination offers many advantages, and
some species make sure that it happens.
■ Some have special proteins on the surface of
the stigma that prevent pollen tubes forming if
the pollen comes from the anthers of the same
plant. These are sell-sterile plants. In cross-pollination, pol len is transferred from anther to stigma of
another plant of the same species. This is risky (pollen may never
■ In some plants, the anther and the stigma are reach the other plant) but offers a greater chance of genetic variation
so far away from one another in the flower that than self-pollination.
Scientists use models of living organisms to study one or two Design an experiment to determine whether colour or
features of the organism. Living organisms may have features scent is the more important stimulus to the honey bees.
that other organisms can detect, but that humans cannot. In your design:
These might affect the results of an experiment, so a model is ■ devise suitable models for the wallflowers
easier to study. ■ clearly state the independent (input) and the
Two students were interested in why honey bees visit dependent (outcome) variables
wallflowers. One of them believed that the colour of the ■ suggest any variables that should be fixed, and say
flower attracted the bees but the other was convinced that it how you would fix them
was the scent. ■ consider whether there are any controls that you
might use
■ draw a table that would be suitable for the
presentation of your data.
®1 State which of the following is unlikely to be involved with pollination in a Malaysian jungle.
A fruit bat B sunbird C jungle cat D great blue butterfly
181
.
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
s The formation of fruit and seed Pollen tube grows down through
and female gametes fuse
to form a diploid zygote.
After the male nucleus has fused with the ovum, the style and acts as a channel
to deliver the male gamete Fertilisation also triggers
the resulting zygote divides many times to from the pollen grain to the some other cells in the
produce an embryo. The development of a seed female gamete in the ovule. ovule to d ivide rapidly
and form a food store
and the structure of the embryo are described in Ovary wall - ovules are - inside the seed.
the diagram on the opposite page. attached to the inside of the
ovary wall by a short stalk. Micropyle - a gap in the
Once fertilisation is complete, the developing covering of the ovule.
Ovule contains the fema le __,,.......,._ The tip of the pollen tube
seed sends hormone messages to the flower, and a gamete, and some other locates this gap and the
number of changes take place: cells which may develop into male gamete enters the
food reserves. ovule through it.
■ The sepals and petals wither away, and may
fall off. Note that only one fertilisation is shown here. Each ovule needs its
own pollen grain and pollen tube t o be fertilised. A plum has only
■ The stamens, stigma and style wither away. one ovule in each ovary, a wallflower has a f ew tens and a poppy
may have thousands of ovules in one ovary!
Stages in the development of a fruit
• Tomato flowers - the petals are • After fertilisation, the petals have • In the ripe fruit, the ovary wall is
still obvious fallen off, the stigma and style have swollen and succulent. What do you
withered and the carpel is beginning think is the purpose of the bright
182 to swell red colour?
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
® 1 In one sentence, explain the difference between 0 Two students suggested that the wallflower
pollination and fertilisation. cannot produce fruit unless pollination has taken
2 Draw a simple diagram of a typical place. Their teacher showed them how to prevent
hermaphrodite flower. On your diagram label: bees reaching the flowers by covering the flowers
a the parts that fall off after fertilisation in a f ine mesh bag, and how to transfer pollen
b the parts that develop into a fruit. with a fine paintbrush.
3 Define the word 'seed' . a Describe how the students could carry out an
0 Classify each of the following as: experiment to test their hypothesis.
a fruit b Suggest how they could modify their
b seed or experiment to test whether self- or cross-
c neither fruit nor seed. pollination produced more seeds in the
Tomato, cucumber, Brussels sprout, wallflower.
baked bean, runner bean, celery, pea, grape In your answer, be sure to describe any controls
which they could include, and any steps they
could take to ensure that their results were valid.
.
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
~ : - - - - Seed coat
(testa)
Protein
Starch Protein
Active
enzymes
Energy ,
Glucose
Inactive ,Al ~ Aerobic _,,r
vvater \ . .
enzymes resp1rat1on
Water Oxygen ~ t
Oxygen
Dormant seed - embryo and food stores Water enters through the micropyle and: Water and oxygen enter through gaps in
are surrounded by an impermeable seed ■ activates enzymes to convert insoluble the testa. Oxygen and glucose enable
coat. The micropyle is the only gap in the stores to soluble foods aerobic respiration, which releases energy.
seed coat. ■ makes tissues swell so that the testa is The embryo is able to grow as it receives
split open. raw materials and energy.
Environmental factors that affect Enzymes work at their optimum
germination are very similar to those temperature.
that affect enzyme activity. This
indicates that germination is a
process controlled by enzymes
(page 40).
Dormancy will continue if the embryo in the seed does not experience the right conditions:
• if kept in anaerobic conditions
■ if kept dry
■ if kept cool.
Oxygen and water cannot reach the embryo if the testa remains impermeable. Some seeds must pass
through an animal's gut (where digestive juices are present) before the testa is weakened enough for
the seeds to germinate.
Seeds kept dry in a vacuum, as in seed packets, can be stored for long periods.
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
--I
A 8 C e
Crcm seeds - -
Dryconon
Wet cotton wool
wool - --+
Wann Warm Cold Warm Wann
fight dark dark light light
Procedure
Dry mass
+
a r - ----========-------------------:~~~~;;;:~-
Mass begins to increase
Dry mass falls as part of food Mass falls more quickly as as first foliage leaves start
store is consumed by respiration . growth of seedling accelerates. to bu ild up food compounds
by photosynthesis.
A Germination of the broad bean. Dry mass is used as a measure of the food stores because wet mass would include water
absorbed from the soil, and the amount of water absorbed and lost can vary greatly.
® 1 Copy and complete the following paragraph. downwards by , providing and absorbing
Before germination, a seed must absorb from the water and minerals for the seedling. The young shoot
soil. The seed coat is impermeable to this substance, or _ appears next. This grows upwards and
and it enters through a hole called the . This eventually bursts through the soil. The first leaves
absorption causes the seed to and split the develop and the seedling is able to produce its own
. The gas can now enter, which is necessary food by
for _ . The energy from this process, together with 0 How would you attempt to prove that germination is
soluble food compounds, allows the to grow. controlled by enzymes?
The young root or _ appears first and grows
185
Questions on plant reproduction
and growth
1 Which part of a flower produces pollen? _22°c + light
_A..._ __ 22°c + dark
A Ovary r ' ~
A B C D
B Anther
C Stigma
D Petal [1]
oil
2 Which part of the flower receives pollen?
boiled water
A Ovary
pea seed pea seed
B Anther
C Stigma
D Receptacle [1]
3 Which one of the following is not a
condition necessary for the germination
of a bean seed? dry cotton wool wet cotton wool
A Table 1
ii Germination is quicker if the temperature
A is raised to 30°C. Explain why. [2]
h Table 2 show how the dry mass of barley
seedings changed over the first 35 days after
sowing.
Time after
0 7 14 21 28 35
sowing / days
-===-a Dry mass/ g 4.0 2.8 2.8 4.4 9.6 17.8
186
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
6 Strawberry plants are able to reproduce between the second and third new
asexually by means of runners. A runner plants. Explain why there would be this
produced in early summer gives rise to a new difference. [2]
plant, which in turn produces a runner to give h What else has to happen to the plant shown
rise to a second new plant and so on. This in the diagram for the process of asexual
process is summarised in the diagram. reproduction to be completed? [1]
Green leaves of Flower
c A fruit grower found that one particular
the parent plant strawberry plant survived two weeks of
make food.
heavy winter frosts. Suggest why the grower
would be more likely to obtain frost resistant
strawberry plants by the asexual method
New plant grows from shown in the diagram than by using seeds
a bud on the runner. produced by the flower. [2]
d i Describe briefly how the strawberry plant
produces food to send to its developing
strawberries. [2]
Soil level
ii Name the plant tissue through which
soluble food products are transported
Runner grows from a bud. along the runner to the new plants. [1]
a Ten different strawberry plants were taken 7 The diagram below shows a carpel - the female
and the length of the runners X and Y part of a flower.
(shown in the diagram) were measured. The
results are shown in the table.
A
Plant number Length of Length of
runner X I mm runnerY / mm
400 200
2 350 280
3 420 260
4 610 260 8
5 640 340
6 600 250
7 340 240 F
8 460 270 E
9 600 250
C
10 520 290
D
i Using the data in the table, calculate the
average (mean) lengths for runner X and
for runner Y.
Show your workings. [2] a State which letter corresponds to:
ii Calculate the difference in mean length i the stigma
between runner X and runner Y. ii the ovary
Show your workings. [2] iii the micropyle. [3]
iii The lengths of the runners X in the table h Copy and complete the diagram to show
vary considerably. Suggest two possible how a pollen grain fertilises the ovule. [2]
causes of this variation. [2] 8 a Define the term cross pollination. [2]
iv Predict how the results would be h Suggest the possible advantage to the
different from those shown in the table if species of this process. [2]
measurements were taken of the runners
.
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
At puberty children
~/ One mal.e .and one female become young adults
(:J--- gamete Join together. capable of producing
~J..
0---
A zygote is formed when the male and female
nuclei fuse. This is fertilisation. The zygote has one
and delivering gametes
(see page 190).
188
t t
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
Part s of the
Opening of vagina
-"<--- - - - - Jelly coat: changes at
f ertil isation to allow entry
of male nucleus
190
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
®1 Explain the importance of the following in the human ii Explain how this will act as a method of
life cycle: contraception .
a fertilisation d A man infected with the human immune-deficiency
b puberty virus (HIV) may transmit AIDS (acquired immuno-
c gamete formation. deficiency syndrome) to another person. The virus is
2 Describe the pathway followed by: transmitted in body fluids. Following a vasectomy, is
it still possible for an infected man to pass AIDS to
a spermatozoa at ejaculation
b an ovum at ovulation. another person? Explain your answer.
3 Where does fertilisation occur? 7 This figure shows a human egg cell and a human
sperm cell.
0 Why is reproduction necessary?
O The table below lists the organs of the female
reproductive system and their descriptions.
Match each organ with its description. Write the letter
and number to show your answer, for example, a-4.
Structure Description
a ovaries 1 the neck of the uterus
b oviducts 2 connects the uterus to the exterior
c cervix 3 link the ovaries to the uterus
d vagina 4 the site of implantation 100 µm
I._ ►I 10 µm
e uterus 5 ova are produced here human egg cell
I• •I
6 The figure below shows the reproductive organs of the
human male after an operation called a 'vasectomy'
has been performed. Following a vasectomy, the man
can still ejaculate fluid produced by the prostate and human sperm cell
Cowper's glands.
a i What is the name given to the release of eggs
from the ovary?
ii Sperm cells and egg cells are haploid.
State the meaning of the term haploid.
b Complete the table to compare egg cells with
sperm cells.
,"-<----+--- Vas deferens
(sperm duct) feature egg cells sperm cells
site of production
relative size
numbers produced
a Name parts A and B. mobility
b Copy the diagram. Put an 'X' to show where sperm
are made.
c i In what way are the reproductive organs of the
male with the vasectomy different from those of
a normal, untreated male?
191
.
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
21 st
7th
2 Repair phase
More blood vessels grow in the
8th lining of the uterus, and the
lining thickens and becomes
I 3 Receptive phase
The lining of the uterus and its
more stable. These changes are
triggered by an increase in the
concentration of oestrogen.
blood vessels are now well Ovulation
developed. If fertilisation has Ovum released
occurred the embryo can from ovary
become buried or implanted
in this lining. This optimum set 14th 13th The release of the ovum is
of conditions for implantation accompanied by a slight
Following the development of a Graafian follicle
remains for 6-7 days after increase in body temperature -
(see top of next page), an ovum (egg) is released
ovulation, and is maintained some women are actually
into the oviduct. Ovulation occurs at the peak of
by an increasing concentration aware of the moment of
oestrogen concentration and is triggered by a
of progesterone. ovulation.
hormone from the pituitary gland.
1
192
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
®1 Define the terms menstruation and ovulation. 0 Use the term feedback inhibition to explain why
What is the link between these processes? contraceptive pills contain the hormone progesterone.
0 Describe the role of the hormones FSH, LH, 4 a List the phases of the menstrual cycle.
oestrogen and progesterone in the control of the b How long does the cycle last?
menstrual cycle. c At what time in the cycle does ovulation occur?
193
.
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
Man
Oviduct - - - -...__
.•- -- - - - - - - - - Sperm duct
O v a r y - - - - - - - - --
Vagina - - - - -- -
194 A Sexual intercourse or copulation delivers male gametes to the female reproductive system
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
~
kind of dish (not a test tube, although the technique is sometimes called
'test-tube fertilisation'). The fertilised ovum is placed in the woman's uterus
to develop. This procedure is used to treat couples who are unable to
conceive. For example, a woman's oviducts may be blocked, preventing
sperm reaching the ovum, or making it difficult for a fertilised ovum to get
'Y Fertilisation is the fusion of ovum and to the uterus.
sperm
Artificial insemination by donor (AID)
If a couple is unable to conceive naturally due to a problem with the man's
sperm, they may try AID. Sperm from a donor is obtained from a sperm
bank (where it is stored) and is inserted into the woman's uterus close to
her time of ovulation.
195
.
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
196
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
A controlled environment
The time taken for the development of a baby from an implanted zygote is called the gestation period.
The developing fetus needs a stable environment which is provided by the placenta, a structure that
is only found in mammals. The placenta forms early in pregnancy, partly from the lining of the uterus,
and partly from the outside cells of the developing embryo. The fetus is attached to the placenta by the
umbilical cord as shown below. It is surrounded by the amniotic sac which is filled with amniotic
fluid; this protects the fetus from knocks and bumps.
The placenta begins to develop at implantation and after about 12 weeks it is a thick, disc-like structure
with finger-like projections called villi that extend deep into the wall of the uterus. The placenta
continues to grow to keep pace with the developing fetus and is about 15 cm across, weighing about
500 g, at the time of birth. After the baby has been born, the placenta, amniotic sac and umbilical cord
are expelled from the uterus as the afterbirth. The structure of the placenta, and some of its functions,
are illustrated in the diagram below.
Vein to mother takes away blood which is: - - - - - . DANGER! Some harmful materials can cross
• low in nutrients and oxygen the placenta and affect the f etus.
• high in carbon dioxide and urea. • Nicotine - a toxin in tobacco smoke. Babies of
mothers who are smokers can be born already
addicted to nicotine.
• Rubella virus - a pathogen which causes
German measles. This disease causes damage
Wall of uterus is well supplied with to the developing brain and nervous system.
blood vessels.
..
·u
,,
'
:
I
I ,
,
Umbilical artery -
I I Umbilical cord carries deoxygenated
Blood-filled space in lining
I
,,
' , blood containing
of uterus. - - - - - - - - --+---,.....-- ,' '
wastes such as urea
away from fetus to
---=--:::!w~==!.-r-_-_-_-_-_-_-_--.
...J ----placenta.
Placental villi are finger-like
projections which provide a large,
thin surface for exchange of
- - - -Umbilical vein -
materials between mother
carries oxygenated
and fetus. - - - - - - - - -- - -
blood cleared of
wastes from
placenta to fetus.
Blood contains a
There is no direct contact high concentration
between maternal and fetal of soluble foods such
blood - they are separated as glucose, amino
by a membrane which can, acids and iron.
to some extent, select the Artery from mother delivers blood which is:
materials that cross it. • high in nutrients and oxygen
• low in carbon dioxide and urea.
A The placenta is the site of exchange - useful substances such as glucose and oxygen pass from
mother to fetus and wastes such as urea and carbon dioxide move in the opposite direction
®0 Name two other parts of the body where villi give the benefit of an increased surface area.
197
.
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
. :
Antenatal care includes ■ advice on diet Weight check: from about the 3rd month
■ guidance on motherhood of pregnancy a woman gains about 1 lb
(450 g) per week. During the whole
■ checks on fetus and mother.
pregnancy she will gain about 30 lb (12 kg).
This includes the weight of the baby, the
Signs of pregnancy placenta and the amn iotic fluid, as well as
first sign - a missed period some fat under the skin. If she gains too
second sign - another missed period, much weight she w ill be advised to diet. J
perhaps with feelings of nausea, tender
r
et should
breasts and more frequent urination.
contain extra calcium (bone growth of
Testing for pregnancy
fetus) and iron (haemoglobin)
Measures the amount of HCG hormone in the
--:-'i---.L.! ■ include protein (growth of fetus) and
urine, using monoclonal antibodies.
extra carbohydrate (mother may need
25% more kjou les)
■ vitamin supplements.
Checks on the fetus
position for the baby is head downwards and facing smoke reduces oxygen transport to
the mother's back. fetus, causing low birthweight).
■ Reduce alcohol intake (alcohol can
7
Heartbeat can be measured, using a stethoscope, damage the nervous system of the
during the second half of pregnancy. The fetal heart developing fetus).
rate is usually 120- 160 bpm, about twice as high as
its mother's! Blood pressure: checked at every visit as
high b.p. may ind icate toxaemia of
Ultrasound scanning is used to produce a picture pregnancy wh ich can be very serious for
of the fetus in the uterus. It provides information on both mother and baby.
■ baby's age, size, sex and position
■ posit ion of the placenta Hormones: the level of oestrogen in the
■ whether there are twins! blood indicates how well the placenta is
functioning to supply the fetus with food
and oxygen.
® 1 What name is given to the complete period from more (a total of four), and so on. Calculate
fertilisation to birth? approximately how many divisions were necessary to
0 The growth of the fetus is due to an increase in the produce the baby from the zygote.
number of cells of which it is made. A newborn baby 3 Cell division is only part of the overall process of
has about 30 million million cells. Remember that each production of the baby. Which other process runs
cell divides into two, and each of those two into two alongside cell division? Define this process.
198
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
Birth is a compromise -
the fetus has outgrown
the placenta's supply
systems but must adjust
to a much more variable
environment.
4 months
3 months Fetus may kick, actual length
actual length curl toes, squint (crown to heel)
and frown. Sex can 120 mm
(crown to heel)
be determined by
70mm external inspection.
Lymph nodes
develop. Face begins to look
'human'. Lobes of
the forebrain
develop. Eye, ear
and nose begin
to look 'normal'. Movements
may begin to be vigorous, and
may be detected by mother
(the fetus 'kicks').
199
.
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
Labour
By the end of pregnancy the baby normally lies with its head against the
cervix, ready to be born. At first the contractions come every 20 minutes
or so and may be quite gentle, but as birth approaches they become
more frequent and more powerful. The contractions cause the amniotic
sac to break and release the amniotic fluid - known as breaking the
waters - and the cervix to dilate (get wider). The first stage of labour
is complete when the cervix is wide enough for the baby's head to
pass through. Labour continues as the baby's head is pushed past the
cervix into the vagina, which is now acting as a birth canal. From now
on the process is quite rapid and may involve powerful and painful
contractions by the mother, helped by the midwife or the obstetrician
(doctor who specialises in birth). The birth process is quite traumatic
for the baby, and it may become short of oxygen as the umbilical cord
is compressed by the walls of the birth canal. The baby's heartbeat is
monitored during birth, and the blood soon reoxygenates once the baby
begins to breathe. When the baby is breathing properly, the umbilical
cord is clamped (to prevent bleeding) and cut. During the third stage of
labour, the placenta comes away from the wall of the uterus and leaves
the vagina as the afterbirth.
s Bottle feeding
The artificial or formula milks intended for use in bottle feeding are based on cows' milk.
Various sugars and oth er substances are added to the dried powder to make it more like
human milk. The differences between cow and human milk are shown below.
The main advantages of bottle feeding are th at th e exact quantity of the baby's food intake
can be m easured, and that people other than the baby's moth er can h elp with feeding. The
m ain disadvantages of bottle feeding are that formula milk is expensive and it is not as easily
digested as breast milk. Also, unless the bottles are carefully clean ed and sterilised and unless
th e milk is made with boiled cooled water, microbes can be p assed to the baby.
In some parts of the world, bottle feeding is a leading cause of gastrointestinal upset and
deficien cy disease in babies. There is an ongoing campaign to encourage breast feeding.
Human milk is low in bacteria and Artificial milk ('formula') is based on cow's milk, but it must be modified since
contains antimicrobial factors so the gastrointestinal tract and kidneys of the human infant are immature and
that breast-fed infants suffer fewer incapable of dealing with the 'richness' of cow's milk.
infections, particularly the
Cow's milk compared with human milk
dangerously dehydrating
Fat High in long-chain, Difficult to digest, inhibits calcium
gastroenteritis. Bottle-fed infants in
saturated fatty acids absorption
developing countries may have a
Protein Three times higher Infant kidneys cannot cope, excess
10- 15 times greater mortality than amino acids may cause brain damage
breast-fed babies. Causes hard curd in stomach - not
High casein:whey ratio
easily digested
Human milk is low cost, is Minerals Very high (particularly Infant kidney cannot cope -
delivered at body temperature, sodium) severe (often fatal) dehydration
requires no preparation and Lactose intolerance - may lead
Lactose Very high
breast feeding encourages a social (milk sugar) to severe disease, the symptoms
bond between mother and infant. of which may include brain damage
Suckling may have a contraceptive
effect, although this is not certain .
®0 Copy and complete the following parag raph about 2 Breast milk contains all the nutrients a baby needs
the birth of a human baby. except for vitamin C and iron . However, the baby
An expectant mother knows when she is about to has sufficient iron stored in its liver for the first
give birth because her begins to experience months of its life. The first milk a breast-fed baby
waves of contraction . These contractions are caused receives is called colostrum. After a few days,
by an increased release of the hormone from normal breast milk is produced. Table 1 compares
the pituitary gland, and become more and more the composition of colostrum and normal breast
powerful as the concentration of the hormone milk.
falls. Eventually the contractions are so powerful that Nutrient / g per 100 cm 3
the _ _ dilates, the _ _ bursts and the 'waters'
Fat Protein Sugar
are released . Further powerful contractions push the
Colostrum 2.5 8.0 3.5
baby through the or birth canal (usually head
Normal breast milk 4.0 2.0 8.0
first, but occasionally feet or bottom fi rst in what is
called a breech birth). Once the baby has been A Table 1
delivered, it is important that it takes deep breaths a Use data from Table 1 to describe how the
because it may have been deprived of _ _ as the amounts of fat, protein and sugar are different in
cord is compressed during delivery. This cord is colostrum and normal breast milk.
b A baby feeding on normal breast milk drinks one
clamped and cut, and relatively mild contractions of
litre of milk per day. Calculate how much protein
the uterus cause the _ _ to come away from the
the baby receives per day. Show your working .
wall of the uterus and pass out of the vagina as the
c Suggest a suitable fruit juice a mother could give
her baby to provide vitamin C.
201
16.11 Birth and the newborn baby*
8 8 8
,
A single ovum is
released from 0
Two ova are
released from
the ovary at 0
I 0 One ovum
is released.
0 A second ovum is released
before the ovary is
the ovary. the same time. 0 'switched off' by feedback
The ovum is Each ovum is but is fertilised inhibition.
fertilised by ij fertilised by a late in the ij The ovum could be
one sperm. different sperm. menstrual cycle. '-0 fertilised a month later,
maybe by a sperm from
The zygote divided @ a different man.
to form an embryo. Each zygote @
forms an ambryo. • •
The embryo /
splits into ~ ~
two identical "=.Y "=.Y
embryos.
.A Identical twins have the same genes .A Non-identical twins are no more .A Multiple births can happen
alike than any other brothers and naturally, or following treatment with
sisters fertility drugs
® 3 Describe the role of hormones in the birth and early c They each have their own placenta and umbilical
growth of a human baby. cord.
4 Consider this list of statements about identical twins, d They may be of the same sex or different sexes.
and say whether each is true or false. e They are also known as fraternal twins.
a They each have the same genes. f They are formed from a single fertilised egg that
b They are formed from two separate ova. splits in two.
202
■ Individuals at greatest risk, (e.g. drug users),
can be offered testing for HIV.
To understand that disease-causing organisms can be
■ Sexual contacts can be traced to identify
transmitted between partners during sexual activity
sources of infection.
■ To name some organisms responsible for sexually
transmitted infections Worldwide involvement can include, for
example,
The control of sexually transmitted infections
■ education programmes to prevent infection
(STis) requires the interaction of individuals
■ provision of antibiotics
and communities. These diseases, some of which
■ development of vaccines and antiviral drugs.
are listed below, are most likely to be transmitted
by body fluids through sexual contact (the STis can be caused by bacteria, viruses or fungi.
responsibility of the individual) but can only
Gonorrhea is a common STI caused by a
be controlled by a concerted effort both locally
bacterium.
and worldwide.
Bacterial STis are treated with antibiotics
Individuals must take care with sexual habits.
( e.g. penicillin) but resistant strains are
An STI can be transmitted quickly through a
developing.
population, so individuals should:
Viral STis are increasing in frequency. These
■ know the sexual history of their partners
include AIDS (acquired immune deficiency
■ use a condom for barrier protection
syndrome).
■ have a medical check if any symptoms occur.
The causes, effects and treatment for gonorrhea
Communities must offer testing and treatment, and AIDS are summarised in the table below.
e.g. by family doctors.
AIDS (caused by
virus, HIV-human
s A flu-like illness in the early
stages. Many AIDS-related
1 Unprotected sex with an infected person
2 Contact with an infected person 's blood
There is no cure. Antiviral
treatment slows down the
immunodeficiency conditions may follow as the 3 From mother to child, during pregnancy progression from HIV+ status
virus) immune system begins to fail - or childbirth to full-blown AIDS. Modern
e.g. fungal infection of the lungs. 4 Sharing syringes while injecting drugs treatments inhibit the enzymes
The virus reduces the number of which the virus uses to copy itself.
lymphocytes and decreases the
ability to produce antibodies.
® 1 Suggest two steps an individual ca n take to reduce 3 Name one viral and one bacterial sexually transm itted
t he risk of named sexually transmitted infections. infection (STI).
2 What are the responsibilities of a commu nity 0 For any one named STI, suggest how individuals, local
health service? communities and scientists worldwide might be
involved in its control. 203
1 Many young women choose to take an oral 50
I I I I
contraceptive in order to avoid pregnancy. An 45 Progesterone
40 I
,-- -- --
oral contraceptive can prevent pregnancy by: Amount 35 1/
A destroying sperm before they can reach of 30 / 1\ I
hormone 25 I \ 1/
an ovum
B preventing a fertilised egg from becoming
in ~lood /
arbitrary
20
15
J
I/ ' 1/
/
the ovaries 0
0 2 4 6 8 1012141618202224262830
D destroying ova that have been released from
Time I days
the ovaries [ 1]
2 In which organ are sperm made? a When are the levels of oestrogen and
A Testes progesterone equal? [ 1]
B Prostate gland h Which process occurred between day 0
C Penis and day 5? [1]
D Vas deferens [1] c Give one function of each of these
3 Birth control is used in many countries to limit hormones:
the size of families. i oestrogen [ 1]
There are different methods of birth control ii progesterone. [ 1]
available to people - some are used by men and d What evidence from the graph shows that an
some by women. ovum was fertilised? [ 1]
a Name the process which occurs when a e Sketch a copy of the graph. Draw a line
204
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
6 The temperature of the human fetus whilst is unlikely to supply. What problem
in the uterus is about 0.5°C above that of its might this cause for the newborn
mother. At birth it emerges into a relatively baby? [2]
cool, dry atmosphere and immediately 7 The diagram shows the structure of the
encounters a problem of temperature control. placenta and parts of the fetal and maternal
a Suggest why the temperature of the fetus is circulatory systems.
above that of its mother. [1]
h Explain how the following help the newborn V
baby to control its temperature:
i from about the fifth month of pregnancy
onwards a layer of subcutaneous fat is
developed by the fetus [ 1]
ii at birth the blood vessels to the baby's
skin constrict very quickly. [ 1] -x
c A baby born prematurely is less able to
control its body temperature and must be
kept in an incubator (see photograph).
i A constant temperature is maintained
z
within the incubator, using a thermostat
and an electric heater. Use this example
to explain the meaning of the term a i Copy and complete Table 1 by
negative feedback. [4] listing the blood vessels that carry
ii Suggest two functions of the hood that oxygenated blood. Use the letters in
covers the incubator. [2] the diagram to identify the blood
vessels. [2]
Genetics
The study of inherited characteristics, and the way
they are passed on from one generation to another,
is called genetics. Our knowledge of the subject of
genetics is expanding extremely rapidly, and this
knowledge depends upon our understanding of the
molecule DNA (see page 208).
When we study inheritance we are looking for
answers to several important questions:
■ What is a characteristic? Why does a cell or • Human sperm x 1000. Only the 'head' (contain ing
organism develop a certain characteristic? the nucleus) enters the egg at the t ime of fertilisation.
206
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
®
I
I
I
I
There is about 2 m of DNA in
Each chromosome ,
I 1 Look around your class.
each human nucleus. In each
contains a very long ~ human, there fs enough DNA This group of humans
coiled strand of DNA. to stretch to the Moon shows many variations
and back! between individuals.
Suggest one variation
A. The structure of a chromosome that is inherited and one
that is acquired.
A great deal of evidence suggests that the chromosomes carry Find three newspaper
genetic information - the information that gives the particular 0 articles that include the
characteristics to a cell: words 'gene', 'genetic'
or 'inheritance' in their
■ If sections of chromosome are transferred from one cell to
headings. Summarise
another, the characteristics of the recipient cell change.
one of the articles in
■ If chromosomes are deliberately damaged, the characteristics of
three or four sentences.
the cell change.
3 a What is a
■ In some cells, the chromosomes are seen to swell when proteins chromosome? What
are being manufactured in the cell. evidence is there that
■ The only difference between the nuclei of male and female cells chromosomes carry
is the presence of one particular chromosome (see page 224). genetic information?
(Males and females certainly have different characteristics!) b When can
chromosomes be
observed? Explain
Remember these definitions!
Chromosome: a thread-like structure of DNA carrying genetic information in the form why this is possible.
of genes.
Gene: a length of DNA that codes for a specific protein.
207
.
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
1
protein
production
of
words:
DNA carries its instructions as coded messages using just four
different chemical compounds called nucleotide bases or
1 responsible
for
characteristic
organic bases (see page 37). The names of the bases are shown
in the diagram below, but you only need to remember their
initial letters (A, T, G and C) to understand how the code works.
~
The DNA molecule is made up of
nucleotides. Each nucleotide contains a Backbone
One nucleotide base, and a sugar-phosphate backbone.
A The structure of DNA. The exact length of the DNA molecule is not known, even for humans. It is very important to
remember that: adenine always pairs with thymine, and guanine always pairs with cytosine.
208
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
S Hair cells contain keratin Antibodies are proteins Base pairing can explain how DNA
a structural protein. which play a part in the
immune response. is replicated*
For one organism to pass on characteristics to
I
its offspring, it must be able to copy the coded
instructions for these characteristics and hand
them on. In other words, DNA in the chromosomes
must be copied or replicated. This replication
must be carried out with great accuracy, since a
ontains
change in characteristics might be harmful to the
in the nervous he enzym organism. The base pairing rule means that the
system bind to rotein) coded sequence on one chain of the double helix
receptor mylase.
proteins automatically determines the coded sequence on
in the the other chain, ensuring accurate replication. The
synapse.
principles of DNA replication are outlined below.
~mes
(proteins) control
The replication of DNA is a vital part of cell
photosynthesis. division. It is particularly obvious in copying
A Cell characteristics depend on proteins. division (mitosis), as we shall see on page 212.
A T A T A T
A short section of DNA,
G C G C G C
with six base pairs. The
molecule is shown
G C G C G C
'unwound' for simplicity,
and letters are used for T A T A T A
the bases.
A T - A T A T
C G C G C G
A Replication is essential for characteristics to be passed from one generation of cells to the next
s
Transcription
The base-pairing rules G- C and A- U are used to
, - - - - - - - - make a messenger RNA (mRNA) molecule against
one strand of the DNA double helix.
mRNA
Translation
Genetic coding rules are used to make a
protein (string of amino acids) against
- - Nuclear membrane the strand of mRNA.
Nucleus tRNA
mRNA leaves nucleus
through small holes in
amino
the nuclear membrane.
acid
Cytoplasm
Ribosome - an organelle, present Transfer RNA (tRNA)
in the cytoplasm or on rough brings amino acids to
endoplasmic reticulum (page 24) the ribosome.
that links amino acids into proteins.
® 1 What are the subunits of a nucleic acid called? c What is the importance of the SEQUENCE of organic
2 Name the four bases in DNA. bases along a DNA strand?
3 DNA exists as a double helix. Name the base pairs that Key:
hold the double helix together. Why is base pairing
Organic base Symbol
important?
4 Define the term DNA replication .
Adenine (A)
--
--
5 Name four proteins that give particular characteristics X
to named cells. y
6 Name one process of which DNA replication is a vital part. Guanine (G)
7 The diagram on the right represents the behaviour of
DNA strands during the early part of cell division.
Use the information in the diagram to help you answer
the following questions.
a Identify the organic bases X and Y.
b Name the process shown in the diagram.
211
.
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
A zygote results from the All cells (except for gametes) contain DNA is
fusion of egg and sperm. two sets of chromosomes; e.g. huma0 replicated
body cells have two sets of 23, a / exactl . Each chromosome now becomes
~ two identical chromatids joined
0
total of 46 chromosomes.
at the centromere.
For simplicity, only one
homologous pair of < oCentrome,e
chromosomes is shown here.
!
Chromosomes become
Mitosis - copying division which attached to a spindle
produces identical daughter cel ls (fibres which run from
one pole to the other).
The individual
The centromere divides and spindle fibres ........, - - chromosomes line
shorten so that the two chromatids in up at the equator
each chromosome separate. They move ~ (midline) of the cell.
to opposite ends of the cell. ~
An adult human
~
has about 50
billion cel ls,
all containing The original cell
the same has now become
genetic
information
as the zygote.
two daughter cells:
■ identical to
one another @ r✓
Vl / Thecell
■ identical to / ,! F
membrane
'pinches in'
parent cell / ~ to separate
■ same number the two sets
of chromosomes r7J\ of chromatids
as parent cell. ~ into two cells.
A Mitosis - copying division. Note that cell division is a continuous process. Although the
212
diagram shows mitosis in a series of stages, in reality each stage merges into the next one.
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
0 ~ =-======i g
up at cell equator.
Spindle fibres separate
Four gametes, each - -----i the w hole chromosomes.
Each chromosome The cell divides. Each cell
containing only one set,
separates into two now has only one
the haploid number
chromatids. The chromosome from each
of chromosomes.
ell divides. ~ homologous pair.
®0 Cells in bone marrow undergo mitosis. Some of these d The human circulation contains about 5 dm 3 of
cells become red blood cells, to replace those lost blood. Each mm 3 of blood contains 5 000 000 red
as they wear out. A typical red blood cell lasts for blood cells. (1 dm 3 = 1 000 000 mm 3 .)
120 days before it is removed from the circulation. Calculate how many red blood cells there are in
a Suggest why red blood cells last for a short time. the human circulation.
b Which organ removes red blood cells from blood? ii The total number of red blood cells is replaced
c This organ stores the main metal ion that forms part every 120 days. Calculate how many cells are
of the red blood cell. Which ion is this, and what replaced each day. How many are replaced
molecule is it a part of inside the red blood cell? each second?
213
.
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
Stem cells
Most of the cells in a multicellular organism are specialised (see
page 26) - each cell or group of cells is adapted to perform a
particular function with great efficiency. An organism begins its
development as a single cell. This single cell then divides to produce
many cells which undergo differentiation as they take on their
specialised functions.
lntestme
214
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
Stem cells are already being used to treat some human diseases
- bone marrow cells in the treatment of leukaemia, for example.
Research continues into other conditions, including spinal cord
damage. It is hoped that replacement of damaged cells in the spinal
cord by embryonic stem cells could help to reverse paralysis, for
example. However, research into stem cell therapy is difficult and
costly, and there are also arguments against this form of treatment.
For Against
■ Stem cells are thought to hold the key that will one day help ■ The use of embryonic stem cells involves the destruction of
unlock the cure for Parkinson's disease, Alzheimer's disease, unused embryos formed from laboratory-fertilised human
heart ailments, Type I diabetes, spinal cord injuries and some eggs. Some people believe that life begins at conception,
congenital disease conditions. so these embryos represent human life and to destroy
■ Stem cells can help in replacing and repairing organs and them is unethical. Researchers point out that many of the
tissues within the body, for example those that have been embryos are those left over after fertility treatment and
damaged due to cancer, as a result of liver cirrhosis, or from would be destroyed anyway.
deep burns. ■ These cells are derived from embryos that are not a
■ They can be used in the study of human growth and cell patient's own, and the patient's body may reject this 'non-
development to test potential drugs and medicines, without self' tissue.
the use of animals or human testers. This necessitates a ■ There may be unknown side effects. In some patients
process of simulating the effect the drug has on a specific suffering from heart disease, for example, coronary arteries
population of cells, in this case stem cells. became narrower following stem cell therapy.
® 1 True or false?
a Stem cells from one individual have the same genotype.
b Stem cel ls can be collected from bone marrow.
c All stem cel ls die once a person becomes adult.
215
17.5 More about cell division*
~ © umanowm
----i._J ® Ad\Jltcell
from patient
Nudeus saved
and cytoplasm
~i} o~ Nucleus removec
cfiscarded
a genebc match
for the pat1e11t' s
tissue - no ,ejectaon
ln~lin-produdng cells
Transplant@d cells
m~p,oduce
msuhnand Adult stem cell cloning
OV'efcome diabetes may produce tissues which are a ge11ette match
f01 lhe patient. so patient will need less
med1catioo Mid cate after the treatment
216
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
® 1 Suggest two reasons why doctors and scientists are interested in stem cel ls.
2 State the two main sources from which stem cells originate.
3 Explain how a doctor or scientist cou ld obtain embryonic stem cells.
4 Name two possible sources of adult stem cells.
5 Suggest two advantages of collecting umbilical cord stem cel ls.
217
.
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
Reproduction: a reminder
Living organisms can pass on their characteristics to the next
■ To recall the features of sexual generation (reproduce) in two ways (page 176).
and asexual reproduction
■ To be able to define the terms Remember, for sexual reproduction:
gene and allele, homozygous ■ two organisms of the same species, one male and one female
and heterozygous, dominant and are required
recessive ■ each individual produces sex cells (gametes)
■ sexual reproduction always involves fertilisation - the fusion of
the gametes
■ offspring receives some genes from each parent, so shows a
mixture of parental characteristics.
In sexual reproduction, a mixture of genes is passed from parents
to offspring. This handing down of genes is not random, and there
are certain rules that govern how genes will be passed on and which
ones will show up in the offspring.
0 Diploid (2n)
cell in testis
0 Diploid (2n)
cell in ovary
Meiosis Meiosis
0 0 0 0 Haploid (n)
gametes
Fertil tion
Remember that a
diploid number The offspring is diploid, but
218
must be an
even number.
0 has received one set of genes
from the father (n) and one
set from the mother (n)
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
Eye colour Hair texture Ear shape Each chromosome has a partner that carries the same
genes in the same positions. One of the chromosomes
in this homologous pair came from the mother, and
one came from the father.
Eye Hair Ear
Chromosomes carry genetic information
as a series of genes. Each gene has its own
position on the chromosome.
C::J E9F -===
1
JIC A-=::,
This is a simplified picture!
Humans have 23 pairs of chromosomes,
and the biggest chromosomes carry
more than 1000 genes! Eye
--
4444
No lobe
Diploid
-
heterozygous
Mei No lobe
w it h a female gamete
Bb - - - - - - - This genotype would
give a brown-eyed
First generation phenotype, since brown
(called t he F1 generation) is dominant to blue.
Now consider a cross between two heterozygous parents (Bb), i.e. with the same
i.....lllllF
genotype as the F1 above:
Parents Bb X Bb
F1 generation
Genotype BB Bb Bb bb
3 brown 1 blue
The inheritance of eye colour. There are two important points about this cross.
In theory, a cross between two heterozygous
parents should produce offspring in t he rat io
1 These results are probabilities (chances). The offspring should be in the 3:1 ratio
of 3 showing dominant to 1 showing recessive. shown, but each fertilisation is random so they may not be. This ratio is more
This can be restat ed as: 'The probability of any likely to be seen in very large numbers of offspring. For human families, a 3:1
offspring showing dominant is 3/4 or 75%;
t he probability of it showing recessive is 1/4
ratio is unlikely since very few mothers give birth to four children at one time.
or 25%'. 2 Every cross between the same two parents is a different event. If two
heterozygous parents produce a child with blue eyes (a 1/4 probability)
220 there is still a 1/4 probability that their next child will have blue eyes.
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
domestic animals. To do this, geneticists use @ or@ @or@ Gametes @or@* @or@
a test cross ( often called a hack cross to the
All Bb At fertilisation Bb or bb
recessive). The principle is outlined on the right.
All brown eyed F1 generation 1 brown eyed: 1 blue eyed
Reminder!
*The heterozygous brown
I
Ratio: dominant to recessive Phenotypes of parents can supply the b allele for If any offspring showing the
a gamete even though it is recessive characteristic result
3:1 ___ Both heterozygous from a test cross, the parent
'hidden' in the phenotype
1: 1 One heterozygous, one of the diploid parent. must have been heterozygous.
homozygous recessive
The results of genetic crosses are sometimes A A test cross can distinguish different genotypes
shown as a pedigree. with the same phenotype
® 1 Draw a diagram to explain how two brown-eyed 1 showing the recessive characteristic. Explain why
parents can have a blue-eyed child. such crosses rarely give an exact 3:1 ratio.
2 Gregor Mendel suggested that a cross between 0 Use a suitable example to explain the value of a
two heterozygous individuals produces offspring in test cross.
a ratio of 3 showing the dominant characteristic to
221
.
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
Parents Aa X Aa
F1 generation
Genotypes AA Aa Aa aa
Phenotype rmal s
lour but g
is carrie
222
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
~T~
s Codominance
Some gen es have m ore than two alleles. For
Phenotype Phenotype Phenotype
example, the gene controlling the human ABO - norma l - some symptoms - very anaemic,
blood groups has three alleles, given th e symbols of anaemia, in may well die
severe cases may without medical
JA, JB and 1°. Neith er of the JA a nd JB alleles is be very weak care
dominant to the oth er, alth ou gh they are both
dominant to 1°. This is called codominance.
It results in an extra phenotype wh en both
alleles are present together. The genotypes and
But ... the s allele gives some
phenotypes are sh own in the table. resistance to malaria (the malarial
parasite cannot reproduce quickly in
Genotype Phenotype sickle-shaped cells) so in parts of the
world where malaria occurs, for
IAIA or IAIO Blood group A example equatorial Africa:
1s1s or 1s1o
IAIB
Blood group B
Blood group AB
~
HbsHbs HbsHbA HbAHbA
1010 die of malaria some anaemia, die of anaemia
Blood group 0
but are resistant
to malaria
The human blood groups are easily detected
by a simple test on a blood sample.
®
0 Huntington's disease (HD) is caused by a dominant
allele (H) - the other allele (h ) results in normal
working of the central nervous system. This diagram
shows how one family is affected by HD.
1st
generation
b Draw a genetic diagram to show how parents B
2nd and C passed on HD to their children.
B
generation c If parents B and C have a sixth child, what are the
chances that it will have HD?
3rd d Most serious genetic diseases are caused by
generation recessive alleles. Explain why a dominant allele that
causes a serious disease may quickly disappear
Key from a population.
Q = Normal female 0 a Draw a genetic diagram to explain the inheritance
of blood group in the Wilson family. Mr Wilson has
D= Normal male
the genotype IAl 8 and Mrs Wilson has the genotype
1010.
@ = Affected female b What is the probability of the Wilsons' first child
being female?
~ = Affected male
c What is the probability of this child being female
(see page 224) and having blood group A?
a What was the genotype of the grandmother, A ? d A person with alleles IA and 18 shows the effect of
Explain your reasoning . both alleles in the phenotype. What term is used 223
to describe this?
.
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
Note that:
■ To understand how sex is determined and inherited
■ The man's sperm determines the sex of his
in humans
children since the woman can only produce
■ To know that some genes are sex linked
gametes with an X chromosome.
■ To understand the pattern of inheritance of
sex-linked genes ■ The sex chromosomes carry genes concerned
with sexual development, such as development
The photograph below shows a complete set of of the sex organs and position of fat stores.
human chromosomes (a karyotype). When all of
■ The sex chromosomes also carry a few genes
the chromosomes are arranged in pairs, there
that code for characteristics that are not
may be two left over which differ in size and
concerned with sex. Since these genes are
do not form an homologous pair. These are the
carried on the sex chromosomes, they may
sex chromosomes. The importance of these sex
show their characteristics only in one sex.
chromosomes is outlined below.
For example, the gene for colour blindness is
\
Jt
.I i( t
bo.•
r' .. I
. r
- ~
~
••
I
I
~
carried on the X chromosome. We say that colour
blindness is sex linked.
& ♦ i: \
'
.....
J
,
,,
,.
• • T The inheritance of sex
11 i;
,ii>" Each human body cell has 46 chromosomes. There are
'
'.. '
!I 22 pairs of chromosomes plus another two chromosomes
,~
I\ 0
• which may not look alike. These are the sex chromosomes.
•
."'..
I
" ... Female cells have two sex chromosomes that are alike
~ Ji
••
"
!~
Q
Jl\JI
,.
~\
•
(called XX) and male cells have two sex chromosomes that
are not alike (XY).
-. V
!a ,f Cell in test is Cell in ovary
'',, 11
16 (male sex organ) (female sex organ)
,. II'
•
- "
I" "
.,
!1
,,
co
&
0 0
• 22
0 or
0
{(
Let C = normal allele and Consider a cross between a carrier woman and Parents xHxh X XHY
c = mutant allele. a normal man: Female - normal Male - normal
Because these alleles are carried on phenotype but phenotype
the X chromosome, it is necessary to a carrier of the
Parents X'Y X x'x'
show the sex chromosomes in the mutant allele
Male: not Female:
pattern of inheritance. For example:
colour blind carrier
Female
Gametes 0) 0 0) 0
v'~
Female, so two
X chromosomes
Heterozygous for
colour blindness gene
Gametes
F1 generation
0 y
0 X'
F1 generation
Male
X'Y - - - Remember - no
'colour blindness'
Male, so only one gene on the
X chromosome Y chromosome
®1 Use a simple genetic diagram to explain why there are approximately equal numbers of male and female babies.
0 Why are males more likely to have red-green colour blindness than females? How could you explain, genetically, a
colour-blind female?
3 Haemophilia is a sex-linked characteristic. The diagram above shows how the allele for haemophilia is inherited.
a Explain why the mother is described as a carrier of this condition.
b If she has one child, what is the probability of her having a haemophiliac son?
225
1 The table below lists some terms for inheritance parental phenotypes blood group A x blood group B
and their definitions.
parental genotypes X
Match each term with its definition. Write the
letter and number to show your answer, for gametes +
example, a-4.
offspring genotype
Term Definition
offspring phenotype blood group 0
a allele 1 the sum of the alleles on the chromosomes
in the nucleus h Use your answer to a to give examples of the
following. The first one has been completed
d phenotype 2 a form of a gene that codes for one of a
pair of contrasting characters for you. [3]
recessive, sex-linkage
Polydactyly is an inherited condition in
humans. The condition is controlled by a single
C
0
_________ which has two alternative
forms. One form causes polydactyly while the
D
l G able to contract
H produces insolin
other does not. E- -
In preparation for sexual reproduction, F
- - - can conduct an
gametes are formed by _ _ _ _ _ _ _ __ electrical impulse
- the gametes fuse at fertilisation to form a a Name the cells labelled A, C and E. [3]
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ __ zygote. Neither parent h Name the processes labelled B, D and F. [3]
has polydactyly, but one of their three children c Suggest the names of the organs or tissues
does. This suggests that polydactyly results labelled G, Hand I. [3]
from a _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ allele and that 0 Cystic fibrosis is a common inherited disease
each of the parents is _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ . [S] caused by a recessive allele. A blood test
3 The gene for the ABO blood group has three can detect this allele. A man and his wife
alleles, JA, JB and 1°. were both found to be carriers of the cystic
a A person with blood group O has parents fibrosis allele.
who have blood groups A and B. Copy and a What is meant by a carrier of the allele? [1]
complete the genetic diagram to show how h Draw a genetic diagram to show the
this is possible. inheritance of cystic fibrosis in any children
Use the symbols, JA, JB and 1°, for the blood of this couple. What is the chance that a
group alleles. [3] child will have cystic fibrosis? [S]
226
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
Key
D Male showing no signs of haemophilia
227
. DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
18. 1 Variation
46
■ To recall that living organisms differ from
one another 42
~
■ To distinguish between continuous and discontinuous 0
Cl
variation ...
Q,l
,a Discontinuous variation
V
~
V is due to the effect of
,a
Living organisms differ from one another. Even Q,l genes only.
C:
members of the same species have slightly different C:
sets of characteristics. Some of these differences 0
-.;::;
.!!! The bar chart of
are inherited from their parents, and others are ::I
c. 'percentage in class'
the result of the environment. The differences 0
c. cannot become a
between individuals of the same species are called ~
Ill smooth curve because
·,.:;
variations. Scientists who study variation are ·.:::
CICI
there are no
interested in questions such as: intermediate classes.
'o
Q,l
■ Are all the variations of the same type? Cl
"C "'
0"'
.:.. .s - - - - - - - - - - - + The bar chart of 'number in class' can be redrawn as a
"' u smooth curve because there are many possible
-~-5"'
.- CII
- 0 ·-C
intermediate classes between the two extremes (the
curve becomes smoother if the classes become smaller,
.. C
CII CII
e.g. 1 cm rather than 5 cm) .
.c "C
E::
:::s .s:
z u
~ ~> '-~0~
'-'1,0 '-~'-J
> '-~~
'-t;,..<:::J
> '-~0~ '-<o<:::J> '-<o0~
'-~<:::J
There could be a dispute about the boundary of these
classes. One observer might use, for example, 127- 31,
_ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ _ 132-6, etc. rather than the boundaries shown.
Classes: height / cm
® 1 Copy and complete the following paragraph. 0 Two students in the first year of secondary school were
Variation occurs in two forms, , which shows clear- carrying out a mathematical investigation. They decided
cut separation between groups showing this variation, to measure the heights of all of the other students in
and , in which there are many intermediate forms their class. The results are shown in the table below.
between the extremes of the characteristic. The first of a Plot these results as a bar chart.
these is the result of alone, whilst the second is b Does this illustrate continuous or discontinuous
also affected by factors. The sum of the genes that variation? Explain your answer.
an organism contains is called its and the total of c Suggest one characteristic that the students could
all its observable characteristics is called the have recorded to illustrate the other kind of variation.
The two are related in a simple equation: equals
plus __ . Height category / cm Number in category
2 Which of the following is an example of discontinuous
121-125 2
variation?
Body mass, chest circumference, blood group, hairstyle, 126-130 4
height 131-135 9
Explain:
136-140 6
a why you chose one of these characteristics
b why you rejected the others. 141-145 4
229
.
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
0_/ ~
n
{7
Normal gene for
haemoglobin
g Haemoglobin gene
has mutated - one
base has changed
~ ~
g \7n
Normal mRNA made Faulty mRNA made
by t ranscription W k by transcription
ea ness
Aching joints
Normal haemoglobin Poor circulat ion Faulty haemoglobin
made by translat ion made by translat ion
◄ Sickle cel l
anaemia. (A
sickle has a
curved blade
for cutting hay.)
230
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
(see page 232). Some may cause harm in one environment but be a benefit
f in another! Sickle cell anaemia is an example of this (see page 223) people
who are heterozygous for sickle cell anaemia are resistant to malaria.
Radiation can increase mutation rates
Mutations occur spontaneously (for no apparent reason), though they
are very rare events. However, a number of factors (called mutagens)
can increase the rate of mutation. Important mutagens are:
■ radiation - gamma, ultraviolet and X-radiation can all damage
DNA and so cause mutations
■ chemicals - tars in tobacco smoke, high concentrations of some
preservatives and some plant control hormones can cause mutation.
Crossing over
Homologous
chromosomes
pair up as Genetic material
7
meiosis begins. is exchanged ~ } ~:;bination
~
between of genetic
Virtually limitless number
chromatids. _ ? material.
c=====.::-::::• ••
:xC:
-
of different gametes
-=
t
Both of these occur randomly in the production
of both male and fema le gametes.
Any male gamete
g can combine w ith
any fema le gamete®
Independent assortment
,,,,.• --- ----·--- -...,
~ i _. (~ "';, There are four
(~ nuu~ • different gametes
1
~ • ',. _____________ ,, from just two pairs
~
Homologous pairs may or of chromosomes.
line up in different ways, Each human produces
producing different (- -------~ i many different
combinations of genes
in the gametes.
::-:.--,..
(~
--.<
~a~etes
~ ) m t is way.
Enormous variation
amongst offspring
, ......................,"
A. Crossing over, independent assortment and fertilisation all lead to variation. There is very
little chance that any two gametes from one individual will be identical. The combined effects of
mutation and sexual reproduction lead to enormous variation between individuals.
231
.
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
Adaptation
As we have seen, living organisms differ from
one another. Some of these variations make
an organism well suited to its environment,
some make no difference, and others make the
organism less well suited to its environment. An
organism that is well suited to make the most of
the limited resources within its environment is
said to show adaptation to its environment, as
shown opposite. The cactus (a xerophyte) and
the water lily (a hydrophyte) (see page 93) are
both well adapted to their environments.
Organisms that are well adapted show high An adaptive feature (adaptation) is an inherited
fitness - the probability that an organism will functional feature of an organism that increases
survive and reproduce in the environment in its fitness.
which it is found.
~ - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - Small ears and tail give less surface
/ area for loss of heat by rafation
Tongue is enclosed in a
thick membrane to limit
water loss by evaporation.
233
.
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
Over-production - all organisms produce more Survival of the fittest - individuals t hat
offspring than can possibly survive, and yet are most successful in the struggle for
populations remain relatively stable. existence (i.e. that are the best
e.g. a female peppered moth may lay 500 , ~ ~i--..r suited/adapted to their
eggs, but the moth population does not environment) are more likely to
increase by the same proportion! survive than those without these
advantages.
e.g. peppered moths: dark-coloured
moths resting on soot-covered t ree
Struggle for existence - organisms trunks will be less likely to be captured
experience environmental resistance, i.e.
by predators than light-coloured moths.
they compete for the limited resources
within the environment.
e.g. several moths may try to feed on the •.
same nectar-producing flower.
Advantageous characteri stics are passed on
to offspring - the well-adapted individuals
are more likely to breed than those t hat are
Variation - w ithin the population t here less well-adapted - they pass on their genes
may be some characteristics that make the to the next generation. This process is called
organisms that have them more suit ed for • natural selection.
this severe competition. e.g. dark-coloured moth parents will
e.g. some moths might be stronger fl iers, produce dark-coloured offspring .
have better feeding mouthparts, be better
camouflaged while resting or be less
affected by rain.
234 A Evolution by means of natural selection
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
Small Average
When food is only available from The two populations now have so
high branches, natural selection many different adaptations that
picks out the taller antelopes. they cannot interbreed. They have
~
Many generations later
Many Many
generations generations ,
~
0 later later ~
Ol
QJ
......
ro
V
-~.....
QJ
.0
E
::,
z
called an 'anvil', whenever feeding in a particular area. ii amongst grasses growing on a sand dune?
It is possible to collect the remains of the shells and d The main points of the theory of evolution by
count the number of each shell type. It is also possible natural selection are listed below.
to collect the live snails in the same area and count the A The number of offspring is far greater than the
numbers of each shell type. number surviving to adult stage.
Collections of both live snails and broken shells were B Variation exists among the offspring.
made in an area where the ground layer plants gave a C Some variations are useful and help the
fairly evenly coloured background. The results are organisms to survive.
shown in the table. D Competition occurs between the offspring.
a How many more live, unbanded Cepaea were E Only those surviving can breed.
collected than banded? Natural selection can change the proportions of the
b Suggest an explanation for thrushes taking more different colours in a snail population. Use the five
banded snails even where there appear to be more points A to E above to describe how this change
unbanded snails in the live populations. might come about.
235
Some examples of artificial selection are shown
below and opposite. The same species can be
■ To understand the process of artificial selection
bred in different ways for different purposes.
Early horses have become specialised as
Making organisms useful to humans carthorses or for racing, for example.
Variation occurs naturally and randomly in all
Maintaining variation
living organisms, but the natural environment
What appears to humans as a valuable
is not the only agent of selection. Ever since
characteristic might not always be valuable in
early humans began to domesticate animals
a natural situation. For example, a Chihuahua
and plants, they have been trying to improve
dog would probably not survive in the wild
them. This improvement is brought about by
because its hunting instincts have been bred
selecting those individuals that have the most
out to make it more suitable as a pet. It is
useful characteristics and allowing only these
very important that humans preserve animal
individuals to breed. This process is called
and plant genes for characteristics that do
artificial selection. Humans have replaced the
not offer any advantage to us at the moment.
environment as the agents of selection. There are
A cow with a limited milk yield may carry
many important examples of selective breeding:
a gene that makes it resistant to a disease
■ Jersey cattle have been bred to produce milk which is not yet a problem in domestic herds,
with a very high cream content. for example. This resistance gene might be
■ All domestic dogs are the same species, but extremely valuable if such a disease ever did
some have been bred for appearance (e.g. become established. For this reason many
Pekinese), some for hunting (springer spaniels) varieties of animals and plants are kept in
and some as aggressive guards (rottweilers). small numbers in rare-breed centres up
■ Wheat has been bred so that all the stems are and down the country. Plant genes may be
the same height (making harvesting easier) and conserved as seeds, which are easy to store,
the ears separate easily from the stalk (making and some animal genes may be kept as frozen
collection of the grain easier). eggs, sperm or embryos.
In t his group of calves, two are larger Artificial insemination
t han t he others. Large cattle carry Male animals, no matter how many useful
more meat so are valuable to a characteristics they have, cannot give
butcher. birth to young animals! So:
These two animals w it h t he • Most male offspring w ill be fattened
desirable characteristic are allowed up for selling as meat.
to breed, and produce a litter. ■ 'Desirable' males may be electrically
stimulated to ejaculate - the sperm is
To increase the chances that the collected and frozen. One male can
two individuals will mate, the easily produce several hundred samples.
cattle breeder will spray cattle sex • The sperm can be taken to a cattle
hormones in the breeding pen. breeding farm and used to inseminate
many females.
If t he 'size'
characteristic
A very large individual is inherited, the
may be mated with one next generation
of its parents. may contain
individuals
that are even
bigger.
Even larger animal
w it h more meat.
23
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
Cabbage Cauliflower
Broccoli
,
L., Select for many
:,r, ,allside buds. Select for
large leaves.
•=--
No sex please!
Selective breeding involves the 'mixing' of
genes at meiosis and fertilisat ion . However,
once a plant breeder has bred a plant wit h
a desirable characterist ic, t hen asexual
reproduction (vegetative propagation) must
be used t o make many copies of it.
Brussels sprouts Kale
2 An island was invaded by a species of bird that preyed on butterflies. In the population of butterflies,
only those individuals that produced a toxic substance as a protection against predation survived.
This is an example of:
A artificial selection
B competition
C immunity
D natural selection [1]
3 Mutation and natural selection are processes which occur at all times.
a Define the term natural selection. [2]
h Suggest why
i bacterial infections which were controlled by antibiotics 50 years ago
are now a problem in hospitals. [2]
ii malaria-carrying mosquitoes in East Africa were almost wiped out by the insecticide DDT in the
1950s, but today cases of malaria are increasing in this area. [2]
5 a In western Europe, 45% of the population have blood group 0, 43% have blood group A, 10%
have blood group B and 2% have blood group AB.
i Plot the data as a bar chart. [4]
ii Explain the form of your bar chart. [2]
h The characteristics of organisms may be altered by mutation.
i Define the term mutation. [2]
ii Suggest two factors which could affect the rate of mutation. [2]
6 Students collected small nuts from a group of trees of the same species growing close to their school
grounds. The nuts were collected at random, and 50 of them were weighed.
238
DEVELOPMENT OF ORGANISMS AND THE CONTINUITY OF LIFE
i Copy and complete the table below for the mass of nuts.
Mass of nut / g Number of individual nuts
0.3
0.4
0.5
0.6
0.7
0.8
0.9
1.0
1. 1
1.2
1.3
1.4
1.5
1.6
[2]
ii Plot the data in the second table as a histogram. [4]
c State which type of variation is shown in the histogram. [1]
7 One of the early chapters in Charles Darwin's book, The Origin of Species, describes the variation of
living organisms under domestication.
a State the name of the type of selection used by humans to breed crops and animals for their own
use. [1]
h Varieties of cereal crops with a lower than normal requirement for water have been produced for
use in some less economically developed countries.
Suggest how a plant breeder might produce a variety of wheat with this important property. [3]
c i Describe how recombinant DNA technology might be used to produce a useful crop variety. [4]
ii Suggest two reasons why scientists are concerned about the use of this technique. [2]
8 Warfarin is used as a rat poison. It prevents blood clotting and so small wounds bleed and the animal
dies.
Some rats are not affected by this substance. Their numbers are increasing.
Explain why this is happening. [3]
239
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
A population is all
of the members of
the same species
(e.g. wildebeest)
in the same area
at the same time.
Air, water
A community is all
and soil
of the populations
make up
of living organisms
the abiotic
in one area (e.g.
environment.
acacia trees, zebra,
wildebeest and grass).
The community is
the biotic environment.
► Organisms
exist in groups An ecosystem is a unit containing the A habitat is a part of the environment that
within an community of organisms and their can provide food, shelter and a breeding site
ecosystem environment interacting together. for a living organism (e.g. a patch of grassland).
241
.
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
OBJECTIVES
not lost but is converted into some other form.
■ To know that the feeding relationships in an ecosystem
During respiration, some energy is transferred
can be expressed as food chains
to the environment as heat. The flow of energy
■ To understand why energy transfer through an
through a food chain, and the heat losses
ecosystem is inefficient
to the environment, are illustrated in the
■ To understand why complex food webs are
diagram opposite.
the most stable
Food webs
Food chains Little energy is transferred from the base to the
The most obvious interaction between different top of a food chain, so a top carnivore must eat
organisms in an ecosystem is feeding. During many herbivores. These herbivores are probably
feeding, one organism is obtaining food - energy not all of the same species. In tum, each herbivore
and raw materials - from another one. Usually one is likely to feed on many different plant species.
organism eats another, but then may itself be food All these interconnected food chains in one part of
for a third species. The flow of energy between an ecosystem can be shown in a food web.
different organisms in the ecosystem can be The more complicated a food web, the more
shown in a food chain, as in the diagram below. stable the community is. For example, in the
forest food web shown opposite, if the number
Energy transfer is inefficient of squirrels fell, the owls could eat more worms,
The amount of energy that is passed on in a mice and rats. The mice and rats would have less
food chain is reduced at every step. Energy competition for food from squirrels, and so might
can be neither created nor destroyed, so it is reproduce more successfully.
Sunlight provides the Producers, usually green plants, Consumers are organisms that obtain Secondary consumers
energy to drive the make their own organic nutrients, food energy by feeding on other organisms. are carnivores. They obtain
food chain. usually using energy from sunlight their energy by eating
Primary consumers are herbivores.
through photosynthesis. other animals.
They obtain their energy in food
compounds obtained from producers
(i.e. plants).
t/)◊
These longer food chai~s are
Decomposers, fungi and many bacteria,
more common in aquatic
obtain their energy and raw materials
from the wastes (e.g. faeces) and remains
LJ habitats. The final consumer
in the food chain is called the
(e.g. dead bodies) of other organisms.
top carnivore.
• Food chains show energy flow through an ecosystem. The position of each organism
in the food chain or food web represents a different trophic (feeding) level.
242
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
s Energy transfer
Less t han 1% of the Respiration losses occur from each trophic
energy released from level. Respiration is not 100% efficient and
the Sun falls onto leaves. eventually all of this energy is lost as heat.
Because of this, food chains rarely have
more than 4 or 5 trophic levels.
Key
@ respiration
I .
Energy transfer to decomposers 1s very
variable, but eventually the entire energy content
of the animal and plant remains will be released
as heat from inefficient respiration.
Prod ucers
243
19.2 Flow of energy: food chains and food webs
Green heron
® 1 Look at the three aquatic feed ing relationships shown on this page and the next.
Make and f ill in a table like this one:
0 Shark fishing is a popu lar sport. Explain what might happen if al l of the sharks
living around a section of reef were captured by fishermen.
244
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
Octopus
\
Sea Turt le ...• -
I
Parrotfish
l Anemone
Jellyfish I t
~~- - - + I-
t - - -'""'
Coral
Zooplankton
Phytoplankton
@
0 Use words from the following list to complete the paragraph about ecosystems. You may use each word
once, more than once or not at all.
decomposition, producer, chemical, carnivore, consumer, photosynthesis, energy, light, elements,
decomposers, herbivore.
In each ecosystem there are many feeding relationships. A food chain represents a flow of __ through an
ecosystem, and always begins with an organism called a __ which is able to trap __ energy and convert
it to energy. An organism of this type is eaten by a , which is a kind of that feeds only on
plant material. This type of organism is, in turn, eaten by a _ (an organism that consumes other animals).
245
.
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
246 .6.. Ecological pyramids represent numerical relationships between successive trophic levels
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
247
19.3 Feeding relationships: pyramids of numbers, biomass and energy
A line transect only records the organisms which actually touch the line.
This can be misleading, and a more representative method is a belt transect.
This samples all those organisms between two lines (say 1 m apart)
and running parallel to one another.
Pitfall traps -
used to sample art hropods moving over t he
soil surface. The roof prevents rain from flooding
the t rap, and also limits access to certain
predators. Any trapped predators can be
prevented from eating other trapped
animals if a small quantity of met hanol
is added to the t rap. Bait of meat or
ripe fruit can be placed in t he trap.
Ground slopes
Pitfall tr aps are often set up on a away from
grid system to investigate the trap for
movements of ground animals drainage
more systematically. Jam jar
sunk into
soil
Other methods
Pooter - Glass
of collection are
used to collect specimens collecting - - ~ Clear
numer ous. Many
of insects and ot her tube ~--Plastic tube are based on some
art hropods. Trees or bushes
form of netting -
are beaten and t he animals
for example, large
fa ll on a sheet or t ray
Cork or _ __ mist nets may be
underneat h. They are t hen
used to collect
collected in the pooter. rubber bung
migrat ing bir ds for
Sucking on the Glass
ident ificat ion and
mouthpiece pulls t he mout hpiece ringing, and sweep
organism along the
nets may be used
collecting tube and into the Gauze covering
to capt ure flying or
specimen t ube. This does t ube opening aquatic arthropods.
not harm t he organism,
and it can then be returned
to its nat ural habitat. Specimen tube
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
Earthworms Ill
e.g. mice can have a small mark clipped into their fur. Woodlice 11111 un
Snails
3 Release the organism to rejoin
its population. 0 a Copy the table and complete it to show the total
number of each animal collected.
b Plot a bar chart of your resu lts from part a .
c Suggest a function of the trap lid, apart from
preventing entry of rain .
d The students used rotting meat in their traps.
Suggest how the types and numbers of anima ls
collected might be different if they had used
rotting leaves.
The teacher suggested that a mark-recapture method
4 A second sample of the population is collected at a later date and
counted. The number of previously marked organisms is noted. might give a more accurate estimate of the beetle
population. The students set up the pitfall traps with
meat as ba it and then marked the beetles they collected
with a sma ll spot of brown water-soluble paint. They
released the beetles into the area they had been collected
from, and that evening reset the traps. On the following
day the numbers of marked and unmarked beetles in the
traps were recorded, as shown below.
5 The population size is estimated using the Lincoln index:
Number of
Number marked Number in
and released \ / second sample beetles in first marked unmarked
. . n X n2 sample - marked beetles in beetles in
Popu Iat1on size = 1 n then released second sample second sample
(
Number of marked 30 12 40
individuals in second sample
e Use the Lincoln index to calculate the total beetle
This method might be used, for example, when comparing
populations before and after a conservation management population in the area.
plan. f Why did the students use brown paint, not yell ow
or red pa int?
• The mark- recapture method g Why did the students use a water-soluble paint
rather than an oil-based paint?
249
.
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
OBJECTIVES
■ To understand that nutrients in dead organisms
Decomposition by microorganisms
are recycled
The remains that are left are decomposed by
■ To know that the process of decay often begins with the
the feeding activities of microorganisms. These
activities of scavengers fungi and bacteria feed by secreting enzymes
■ To know how saprotrophic nutrition is responsible
onto the remains and absorbing the digested
for decomposition products. This form of nutrition is called
saprotrophic feeding.
Lipases
fats - tatty acids
+ glycerol
Environmental
Metabolism inside the bacterial Amylase
factors may
or fungal cells uses the absorbed starch - maltose
affect
products for respiration or for cell
growth and division. +
glucose
decomposition*
i bed
simple corn ounds
Proteases
protein - amino acids
Absorption by
diffusion and/or
by active transport.
Antiseptics and disinfectants
kill the living organisms that
carry out the decay process. Simple compounds
Good news! in hospitals and include fatty acids,
for food preservation glucose, amino acids
but and mineral salts.
Bad news! in compost heaps
and in sewage works.
®
1 Copy and complete the following paragraph. 0 Gardeners often place vegetable waste on a compost
During the process of decay, __ and __ convert heap. Over the course of time the waste will be
complex chemicals into __ ones. For example, decomposed.
proteins are converted to , and to fatty a What do gardeners gain from the decomposed
acids and glycerol. These decay processes involve the waste?
biological catalysts called __ , and so the processes b Why do gardeners sometimes spray water over the
are affected by changes in and . Humans heap in warm summer weather?
exploit decay, for example in the treatment of __ to c Why do gardeners often build compost heaps on a
provide drinking water, and may deliberately limit pile of loose-fitting sticks or bricks?
decay, for example in the preservation of
251
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
OBJECTIVES
atmosphere). Other processes may affect this
■ To recall why living organisms need carbon-containing regular cycling of carbon.
compounds
■ Sometimes conditions are not suitable
■ To appreciate that carbon is cycled between complex for respiration by decomposers, and
and simple forms by the biochemical processes of carbon dioxide remains 'locked up' in
photosynthesis and respiration complex carbon compounds in the bodies
■ To understand that formation and combustion of organisms. For example, anaerobic, low
of fossil fuels may distort the pattern of the carbon cycle pH or extreme temperature conditions will
inhibit decomposition - this is how fossil
Carbon-containing nutrients - fuels have been laid down in environments
a reminder where decomposition is not favoured.
The Sun keeps supplying energy to food chains. ■ Over millions of years the formation of fossil
However, the supply of chemical elements to fuels has removed carbon dioxide from
living organisms is limited, and these elements the environment. Humans have exploited
must be recycled. The nutrient elements are fossil fuels as a source of energy over a
cycled between simple forms in the non-living relatively short time, and the combustion
(abiotic) environment and more complex forms of oil, gas, coal and peat has returned
in the bodies of living organisms (the biotic enormous volumes of carbon dioxide to
component of an ecosystem). Living organisms the atmosphere. As a result, carbon dioxide
require carbon-containing compounds as: concentrations are increasing (see page
■ a source of energy, released when carbon- 292).
containing compounds are oxidised during S ■ The burning of biomass fuels such as wood
respiration (particularly carbohydrates and and alcohol uses up oxygen, returns carbon
fats) dioxide to the atmosphere, and can have a
■ raw materials for the growth of cells very severe local effect although worldwide
(particularly fats and proteins). it is less significant than the combustion of
fossil fuels.
Recycling carbon compounds
Plants, and some bacteria, manufacture these The way in which these different processes
compounds from carbon dioxide during contribute to the cycling of carbon is illustrated
the process of photosynthesis (see page 46). opposite.
Animals obtain them in a ready-made form
by feeding on other living organisms (see
page 62), and decomposers obtain them as
®0 Refer to the carbon cycle opposite.
they break down the dead bodies or wastes a Name the simple carbon compound present
of other living organisms. These processes in the abiotic part of the ecosystem.
of feeding, respiration, photosynthesis and b Name two compounds present in the biotic
decomposition recycle the carbon over and part of the ecosystem.
over again. Theoretically, the amount of carbon c Which processes raise the concentration of
carbon dioxide in the atmosphere?
dioxide fixed by photosynthesis should equal
d Which process reduces carbon dioxide
the amount released by respiration. As a result,
concentration in the atmosphere?
the most accessible form of carbon in the non- e Name the process that distributes carbon
living environment, that is carbon dioxide, dioxide throughout the atmosphere from
remains at about the same concentration places where it is released.
year after year after year (about 0.03% of the f Suggest a reason why some fossil fuels were
formed as sediments at the bottom of ancient
252 seas.
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
Proteins
Combustion - releases
carbon dioxide by the
burning of fossil fuels.
This increases the Proteins
concentration of CO 2
available in the
environment.
Organic compounds in
POLLUTO decomposers - bacteria
- lead and fungi
free
® 1 Use your knowledge of t he nitrogen cycle to explain c planting peas or beans every th ird year
how the following farming practices might improve d adding NPK fertiliser
soil ferti lity. e adding well-rotted compost.
a plough ing in stubble rather than burn ing it 0 Explain why farmers drain waterlogged fields.
b draining waterlogged fields
254
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
Nitrogen fixation
Denitrification
Absorption by diffusion
and active transport Farmers drain and
plough fields to
improve oxygenation
of soil and so reduce
denitrification.
Feeding They also add
nitrogen-containing
fertilisers to directly
increase the nitrate
content of the soil.
Nitrification
Death and
excretion
Organic compounds in
decomposers - bacteria
Farmers are encouraged and fungi Amino acids Ammonium
to plough roots and and urea ions (NH 4+)
stalks of harvested crops
back into the soil. This
provides raw material
for the action of Decay - enzymes digest
decomposers. organic molecules to
simpler forms
r 7
255
.
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
Recycling water
Life continues on this planet because water has
special properties. In particular, all three states of
water - solid ice, liquid water and gaseous water
vapour - exist at the temperatures found on the
Earth's surface. The temperature varies at different
times and at different places on the planet, but
the average temperature over the Earth's surface
is about 16.5 °C. This means that ice, liquid
water and water vapour are all present and are
continually interchanging. Water is recycled
between different parts of the environment, as
shown in the water cycle diagram opposite. Water is an Water can be a Water is an excellent
excellent biological reagent, transport medium
The water cycle lubricant, for example in the for many biological
molecules, such as
for example in processes of
All of the elements that make up living organisms, saliva or in the photosynthesis oxygen, glucose,
not just carbon and nitrogen, are recycled. The synovial fluid of and digestion. amino acids, sodium
movable joints. ions and urea.
water cycle is different to the cycles of carbon and
nitrogen because:
■ only a tiny proportion of the water which is
recycled passes through living organisms
256
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
Condensation
vapour ➔ water droplet s,
which collect to form clouds
Evapotranspiration
l i qu i d ➔ vapour
Evaporation Melting/refreezing
liquid ➔vapour solid ~ liquid
.A. The water cycle is maintained by heat energy from the Sun
® 1 a Amino acids in the muscle protein of a cow may be found in the muscle protein of a rabbit after several
years. Explain how this is possible.
b Explain how fungi and bacteria play a part in the nitrogen cycle.
2 Use words from the following list to complete the paragraphs about ecosystems. You may use each word
once, more than once or not at all.
respiration, decomposition, producer, chemical, carnivore, consumer, photosynthesis, energy, light,
elements, decomposers, herbivore
In each ecosystem there are many feeding relationships. A food chain represents a flow of __ through an
ecosystem, and always begins with an organism called a which is able to trap energy and
convert it to energy. An organism of this type is eaten by a , which is a kind of that feeds
only on plant material. This type of organism is, in turn, eaten by a __ (an organism that consumes other
animals).
The process in which light energy is transferred into a chemical form is called __ - eventually the energy
is released from its chemical form during the process of This process provides energy for all living
organisms, including __ which are microbes that feed on the remains of animals and plants.
3 Many people are concerned about the effects on the environment of rearing cattle for food .
a Explain why growing vegetables for human consumption instead of raising beef cattle results in fewer
energy losses.
b Suggest one way in which rearing cattle can result in a loss of biodiversity.
c Explain how eating less meat in the USA and Western Europe could help to feed the world's growing
population.
257
1 The following organisms were found living in a i Name the processes represented by the
the same habitat. letters A, B, C and D. [ 4]
caterpillar, fox, greenfly (aphid), green plant, ii Name the most abundant carbohydrate
hawk, ladybird beetle, rabbit, small bird in a plant cell. [1]
a Copy and complete the diagram below by h Measurements suggest that the carbon
filling in the names of the organisms to dioxide concentration in the atmosphere is
show their feeding relationships. rising. Suggest how this is happening. [2]
[4]
h This type of diagram is called a food web. C
Explain the meaning of the arrows in the
food web. [1]
C i Name two organisms which are primary
consumers. [2]
ii Name the organism which is the D
producer. [1] A food chain can be represented by a pyramid
d Myxomatosis is a disease which kills of numbers. Match each of these food chains
rabbits. Suggest two possible consequences with the correct pyramid.
of a reduction in the number of rabbits. [2] grass seed ~ mouse ---"? weasel
2 The diagram below shows the carbon cycle oak tree ---"? aphid ~ ladybird
in nature. cabbage ~ caterpillar ~ wasp parasite
oats ----? rabbit ---"? flea [4]
Carbon dioxide
in air 4 Several types of bacteria involved in the
nitrogen cycle are listed below.
decay bacteria, denitrifying bacteria, nitrifying
bacteria, nitrogen-fixing bacteria
Fossil Carbon D Carbon
fuels compounds compounds
in animals in !ants
:oeath:
:- - i=ossiiisaiion-:
: over millions • ·--r-J /:oeath-:
---J
: ofyears :
·------------- Carbon compounds
258 in dea d plants and
animals
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
NITROGEN
(in the air)
A lightning B
!
SOIL
The empty boxes represent
types of bacteria .
NITRATES
C
Plant protien ~
D
/
excretion B
AMMONIA~- - - - ~
a The diagram above summarises the nitrogen 6 The table below lists some terms used in
cycle. Match the letters in the boxes with the ecology and their definitions.
names of the bacteria active at each stage. Match each term with its definition. Write the
[S] letter and number to show your answer, for
h Soil nitrates are taken up by plants. They example, a-4.
can be produced by the two methods shown
Term Definition
in the diagram.
a ecology 1 an area that can supply food, shelter and a
Suggest another way in which soil nitrates
breeding site
may be increased. [ 1]
b community 2 the study of living things in relation to their
environment
5 The diagram below represents the water cycle.
c habitat 3 the physical and biological conditions that are
a Name the processes represented by the
present in the place where an organism lives
letters P and R. [2]
d population 4 the living organisms of different species which
h Name two factors that could affect the rate live in a particular habitat
of process R. Explain your answers. [4] e environment 5 the number of individuals of a particular species
c State two reasons why water is essential for present in a particular habitat
green plants. [2] [4]
259
.
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
I
I
'
l
I
I
,,
I
I
-- ... ---···· ···············L<<,~.------'
',
•.
..
....
C
0 ~
,•
,
·.:: I •
.!!! I The carrying capacity is
::,
Q. I the maximum number of a
0 1
Cl.
,I Environmental resistance
species that the habitat can
I hold. It is determined by the
I (limiting factors)
I availability of nutrients,
.,I becomes dominant,
increasing the death rate
shelter and breeding sites .
I
I The population falls when
I and/or decreasing the
I resources are used up faster
.I birth rate .
I than t hey are replaced.
I
,,
✓
, ,
., .,
,, .,
__ .,,.,".,,,.
Time
® 1 What is meant by the term environmental resistance? 0 Give examples of the ways in which humans
Give an example. exploit their knowledge of the factors affecting
2 Define the terms biotic and abiotic factors, and give population growth.
examples of each.
261
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
"'0C
4000 {}
great competition for available land
and
greater effects on the environment
"'
iii
::, 3000
~
·s:
:s
.5: '-------1 Medical revolution - improvements in sanitation
0
... and the control of infectious diseases reduced the
~ 2000 number of deaths.
E
::,
z
,._____, Industrial revolution - the development of machinery
increased agricultural efficiency and improved housing
conditions. More people earned enough money to be
1000 able to afford larger families, and the number of
births increased .
A. Human population of the world Human success may be This is largely due to behavioural skills which:
measured as: ■ allow solution of complex problems
■ worldwide distribution ■ allow control/modification of environment
• large number of individ uals leading to changes in carrying capacity
■ dominance over other species. of the environment.
262
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
~~' +
_ Births :
'
,------- ----- --
.. : Population - •I
·------- -------
I
:
_ _ _ _ _ rate and few deaths amongst young people.
Deaths I
All population pyramids show a higher
proportion of females in the older age groups
(the two
Emigration
X chromosomes offer genetic benefits against
sex-linked conditions, see page 225).
A Factors affecting population size Population pyramids for two contrasting
nations are shown here.
If immigration and emigration remain stable,
the population size will depend on the relative
LEON Males Females
numbers of births and deaths. If the population
■ wide base
size is measured, and then the data is broken
65 ---------------- ----------------
down into different age groups, a population ■ low height
OBJECTIVES
■ increased use of inorganic fertilisers
■ To understand why agriculture is a threat to affects plant diversity dramatically and can
conservation result in excessive nitrate levels in rivers,
■ To understand how careful management can help to leading to eutrophication (page 274)
conserve biodiversity ■ use of pesticides to eliminate competitors
for crop species has caused the reduction in
The human population is increasing and may population of many native wildflowers and
reach 9 billion (9 000 000 000) by the end of the some non-target insects and birds by direct
century. More people means a demand for more toxicity or, more often, by removal of their
food. This food is mainly provided by agriculture food sources. Pesticides include insecticides
- the management of land for food production. to improve the quality and yield of crops by
Around the world, agriculture presents a serious killing insects, and herbicides which reduce
threat to conservation of existing habitats. competition with weeds
Although 75% of England is designated as ■ the tendency towards monoculture
farmland, only 2% of the UK population is ■ selective breeding of both crops and
involved in farming. In 1850, one farm worker livestock.
produced enough food for about 4 people; now
All of these can have negative effects on the
in advanced agricultural countries the same
environment.
worker produces enough for 60 people. The
enormous rise in productivity of land is due to It all boils down to monoculture!
many factors. These include: Farms used to be small and mixed, supplying
■ increased and more efficient use of
enough food for just a few families throughout
machinery has resulted in increased field the year, but now tend to be large and specialised.
sizes and the removal of hedges (see page Growing a single crop in this way is called mono-
266) culture and, as ever, there are pluses and minuses.
Monoculture
= (Bad points)
c} (Good points)
Poor wildlife foods: very
Specialised harvesting / little variety of 'weeds' for
techniques: one type of / insects and birds.
machine can collect all
of the crop. Spread of disease: plant
pathogens, such as potato
blight fungus and tobacco
mosaic virus, spread easily:
Highly selected strains: it's not very far to the next
varieties of plants with ideal food plant!
desirable characteristics
(see page 236) can be _ _ _ Loss of genetic variety: may mean
'matched' to the conditions. that any change in environmental
resistance (see page 260) could
damage or kill all of the plants.
Veterinary care:
Temperature control: essential so that ■ Antibiotics to reduce bacterial infection.
costly heat energy is not wasted.
Vaccination to minimise viral infection.
• If too high, animals are uncomfortble Hormone/vitamin supplements can be
and w ill not feed.
administered more accurtely than in the diet.
• If too low, food intake is 'wasted' on
• Artif icial insemination techniques can
heat production to maintain body
reduce costs (no need to keep bulls in
temperature. dairy farms).
Intensive farming can provide more food but there are disadvantages:
■ Waste (faeces and urine) can pollute nearby rivers and lakes.
■ Animals may suffer as they are not in normal social groups.
■ Disease can spread easily from animal to animal.
■ Use of antibiotics can select resistant strains of bacteria (see page 175).
■ Heating and lighting are expensive - and cause more environmental damage.
The problem for the world is how to balance productivity (more food for humans) and
biodiversity (keeping the wide range of wildlife).
®1 Intensive farming of cattle has reduced the cost of meat, but has some disadvantages.
Explain why
a the use of antibiotics to reduce infections in cattle, and
b the addition of growth hormone to animal diets might be harmful to humans who consume the meat.
265
.
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
Advantages Disadvantages
Hedges act as windbreaks which provide ------f..,..::::~ ~~ ~ - - - - - A hedge takes up space that could be
shelter for domestic animals, protect fragile occupied by crops and reduces economic use
crops, limit soil erosion and reduce water of modern agricultural machinery.
losses by evaporation from soil. A hedge
1 m in height provides these benefits for
approximately 2 m to its sheltered side.
Hedge may shade crop species (compete with
them for light).
Taller hedges offer secure nesting sites for
up to 65 bird species. These species may May be a source of insects, and viral and
be important predators on pest species on fungal pests (although such species are often
local crops. specific and are therefore unlikely to be pests
of local crop species).
Roots improve soil stability and limit both Maintenance of hedges is labour intensive
wind and water erosion. compared with barbed-wire boundaries.
266 A The removal of hedgerows in Britain averaged 8000 km per year in the twentieth century. This represents
a disaster for wildlife.
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
Deforestation - t he rapid
destruction of woodland
Climatic changes
■ Reduced transpirat ion rates and drier atmosphere affect the water cycle and reduce rainfall.
■ Rapid heat absorpt ion by bare soil raises the temperature of the lower atmosphere in some
areas, causing thermal gradients which result in more frequent and intense winds.
15%
of the
Famine world's
population
Increasing population receive fewer
Improved medical services may than 10 000 kJ
mean that populations increase per day
(see page 262). As the number of
people increases, the need for food
increases too. At the same time,
greater numbers of domestic
► Unequal distribution of food
Some areas produce more food,
animals may reduce the amount of either because of a more suitable
land available for food production. environment (e.g. water availability)
or more advanced agriculture (e.g. use
of fertilisers). Food surpluses in one
Drought area cannot always be moved to areas
Water is essential for plant growth where food supplies are limited.
and for the health of domestic animals.
►
Global warming (see page 271) may
upset rainfall patterns and so make
less water available. This can
dramatically reduce crop yield.
Flooding
Although plants such as rice grow
in flooded conditions, unpredictable
flooding can reduce crop yield severely.
Plants (e.g. maize) can be damaged
►
and fertile soil can be washed away.
Transportation
Bulky foods are expensive to transport.
Foods with a high water content (e.g. milk)
do not give good 'food value per transport
cost'. Perishable foods may not remain in
good condition during long periods of transport.
Food mountains
in
rich countries
Milk
Self-sufficiency
It makes more sense to help poor Price controls
people to grow food for themselves Taking cheap food from a rich country to a
than to send food surpluses to them. For example poor one can artificially lower food prices in
• Education about agricultural methods the poor region. This can upset the local
• Provision of water supplies by digging wells. economy, and reduce the incentive for
indigenous people to grow their own food.
269
.
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
OBJECTIVES
■ To understand that humans can alter their environment Causes, effects and remedies for
■ To understand how changes in human population pollution
have altered our impact on the environment Pollution is any effect of human activities upon
■ To consider human impacts in terms of cause, effect the environment, and a pollutant is any product
and possible remedies of human activities that has a harmful effect on
the environment. When looking at pollution, we
Humans already are, or could easily become, shall consider three key points:
■ What is the cause?
the most significant biotic factor in every
■ What are the effects?
environment. Primitive humans had a temporary
effect on the environment - hunting, fishing and ■ What are the solutions?
270
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
Effects
Visible and
Global warming (raised temperatures close t o the Earth's surface)
infrared
causes:
--- ---------
,., .... -
■ greater climatic extremes - strong winds, heavier 35 km ..... -
rainfall and unseasonal weat her
• melt ing of polar ice and changes in density of sea all may
water - rising sea levels and flooding
cause loss
• evaporation of wat er from fertile areas - deserts of crops
form
■ pest s may spread to new areas Lower
But stratosphere
• higher t emperatures and more carbon dioxide mean more
photosynthesis and more food production .
15 km.,. ,.,,.,
,,
,, ,,
Solutions Troposphere
To limit the effects of greenhouse gases, humans should:
• reduce burning of fossil f uels - explore alternat ive energy sources
• reduce cutting of forest s for cattle ranching or rice growing
• replant forests. Earth 's
surface
.6. Some gases added to the atmosphere act like the panes of glass in a greenhouse and raise the temperature
close to the Earth's surface
•I§ EI I I I ii fl fJ
3 4
'Acid' rain
5
6 7
7
'Pure' rain
8
'Acid' lakes and fields can be improved by t he addition
catalysts
.6. Acid rain damages both living organisms and buildings made by humans. Acid rain also causes pollution of 271
water. Some lakes are almost empty of life as a result of pH levels as low as 4 or 5.
20.4 Human impacts on the environment: pollution
Nuclear weapons
- - - - - - - -0
Nuclear weapon tests that are conducted above ground or under water can release radiation into the
atmosphere. A nuclear test is the explosive test of a complete nuclear warhead - some tests in the
twentieth century were conducted in areas occupied by soldiers. Most of the troops ordered to take
part in the testing programme were not equipped with any specialised protective clothing. They were
simply ordered to tum their backs or cover their eyes to avoid being blinded by the flash of the explosion.
One former soldier remembers having his hands over his eyes but the flash was so bright that it acted
like an X-ray and he could see all the bones in his hands.
Exposure to radioactivity frequently leads to various forms of cancer, including leukaemia. The troops
involved have suffered much higher cancer rates than normal. However, because cancer may take
years to develop, it is difficult to prove that a particular case is linked to a particular cause.
272
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
Non-biodegradable plastics
Plastics are widely used as packaging and transporting
materials. They are useful because they can be shaped to form
different products, they are light and they protect products
(especially foods) from fungi and bacteria.
Many plastics are made from large hydrocarbon molecules and
cannot be decomposed by normal microbial methods. Because
they are so widespread and they are non-biodegradable, they
• Non-biodegradable plastics cause
can have severe environmental effects.
marine pollution
They can pollute both aquatic and terrestrial habitats.
■ They can block the passage of water through drainage channels, leading to waterlogging of
soils. This reduces oxygenation and so affects soil fertility.
■ They can be mistakenly consumed by animals, on both land and in water. They block the
animal's digestive system and cause many deaths.
■ They do not allow the passage of oxygen, so when they are present in landfill sites they inhibit
natural decomposition of other wastes.
■ If they are burned in an attempt to remove them they release toxic 'smoky' particles, which can
affect breathing and have a long-term effect on health.
These plastics are very light, and so when discarded they easily blow from place to place. They
make the environment less attractive (they lower the amenity value of the environment) and often
become lined up against natural windbreaks such as hedgerows and stands of trees.
Pesticides
Causes
--
pesticide levels in water. The pesticide levels are
>I ,
then amplified as they pass through food chains.
For example, one stickleback may consume 500
Daphnia. The living matter in the Daphnia will
~
~
....... • .. • I
412:r«
~ :>
be used for raw materials or lost as heat but Water Plankton Daphnia Stickleback Grebe
the pesticide remains concentrated in the 0.02 5 50 250 1500
tissues of t he stickleback.
Effects Solutions
High concentrations of pesticides may accumulate in t he ■ Use degradable pesticides - DDT, for example, lasts for a long time and so
t issues of top carnivores. The pesticide may be toxic (and its use is banned in many countries.
kill t he carnivore) or may affect its metabolism. DDT, used ■ Explore alternative methods, such as biological pest control.
to control mosquitoes in malarial zones, severely reduced ■ Crops t hat are genetically modified to resist attack by insects may reduce
breeding success in birds of prey. the need to use insecticides.
b how scientists might be able to increase the amount aquatic organisms (causing
imbalance of gender in fish
of this organism so that it could be used to degrade
populations, for example).
plastics.
273
.
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
-------------
Farmyard runoff
ients to multiply
algal bloom.
Reduction of light for
bottom-growing plants
Aerobic organisms
(fish and invertebrates)
..,____ ___ Large quantities of
organic material
die from lack of oxygen.
Aerobic decomposers
(mainly bacteria)
multiply and
consume oxygen.
Unnaturally high levels of nutrients: Depleted oxygen levels in water ■ Treat sewage before it enters rivers (see page 282).
• from leaching of fertilisers cause death of fish and most ■ Prevent farmyard drainage entering rivers and ponds.
■ from input of raw sewage invertebrates. High nitrate levels ■ Control use of fertilisers:
• from liquid manure (slurry) can be dangerous to human - apply only when crops are growing
washed out of farmyards. babies. - never apply to bare fields
- do not apply when rain is forecast
- do not dispose of waste fertiliser into rivers and ponds.
• Bubble a stream of air through badly polluted ponds.
275
.
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
OBJECTIVES
We must aim for sustainable development.
■ To understand that humans may have a This means that we should not alter our environment so much
that we take things away and harm the environment for future
beneficial effect on the environment generations. We should still provide for the needs of an
■ To realise that conservation often involves compromise increasing population .
■ To understand a conservation strategy
■ To know some examples of successful conservation Endangered species
Competition between humans and other living
Humans do not always damage the environment - organisms means that many species have
growing numbers of conservationists try to disappeared or declined in number. The reasons
balance the human demands on the environment for this are not always understood, but the
with the need to maintain wildlife habitat. They following may be to blame:
will try to assess the likely effects of any human ■ Pest control - the term pest includes any
activity by producing an Environmental Impact species that causes inconvenience to humans.
Statement. Many species have been hunted ruthlessly,
such as red deer (which damage trees), and
Forest management also predators such as cheetahs, and scavengers
Humans have been responsible for deforestation such as vultures.
of much of the Earth's surface. Humans have ■ Commercial exploitation - species of value to
also set up schemes for the large-scale planting humans have been exploited, such as the tiger
of trees - in areas that have been cleared which has been hunted and trapped for fur and
(reforestation) or in a new site (afforestation). medicinal compounds.
■ Loss of habitat - more land is being used for
There are a number of reasons for planting trees:
agriculture, including previously unusable land
■ as a cash crop, providing timber for building
that has been drained. This removes habitats
(coniferous plantations in the UK) or for fuel for many species, such as wading birds and
(fast-growing eucalyptus trees are widely amphibians.
planted in central Africa) ■ Climate change - loss of ice from the Arctic
■ to reverse soil erosion, particularly valuable in reduces hunting sites for polar bears.
areas that have become deserts ■ Pollution - ponds and rivers may be polluted
■ to provide valuable wildlife habitats - for by fertilisers and sewage. Many oxygen-
example, Scots pine plantations are important requiring species can be lost (see page 275).
habitats for red squirrels ■ Introduced species - predators such as stoats
■ as recreational areas, providing leisure activities and weasels introduced to offshore islands can
such as camping and mountain-biking. eliminate ground-nesting birds.
Conservationists work to slow down or stop the
A well-managed forest can combine all of these decline in biodiversity (the number of different
functions and maintain this valuable resource. species), and also to raise public awareness of the
need to maintain species and their habitats. The
A sustainable resource is one which is produced as rapidly as number of different species in a community of
it is removed from the environment, so that it does not run out. living organisms can be described by a formula
called the Species Diversity Index.
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
A conservation plan involves several stages: Zoos are areas of confinement keeping samples of
■ sampling to assess the number of organisms species alive under varying degrees of captivity.
■ devising a management plan - for example, The role of zoos in captive breeding is becoming
trying to increase a species' population based more and more important. For example, the
on knowledge of its breeding requirements Arabian oryx had been hunted to extinction in the
■ carrying out the plan wild but zoos in London, San Diego and Phoenix
■ re-sampling to assess the number of the have provided animals to release in Oman and
'conserved' species once more, and find out Jordan.
whether the conservation plan has worked. Education can help.
■ Local people can be taught about the tourist
As populations decrease in size, genetic variation
value of conserving species.
(see page 228) is reduced and a species may
■ Students can be taught about keeping complex
become more vulnerable to environmental change.
food webs and about the management of
habitats.
u
Conservation programmes are needed:
■ to reduce the risk of extinction
■ to protect vulnerable environments Plants need help too: the value of
■ to provide valuable resources, such as food, drugs, fuel seed banks.
and genes.
■ Seeds can survive for long periods in a dormant
state (see page 184).
■ Seeds of threatened plant species can be collected
and stored - usually in cool, dry conditions.
■ Conditions can be manipulated to stimulate
germination of seeds when more plants are required.
® 1 Many plants contain chem ical compounds not normally found in animals.
Explain why it is important that scientists try to conserve individual plant species before development of roads,
housing and agriculture might eliminate them. Include an example in your explanation.
277
.
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
Setting of quotas
Governments set quotas in an attempt to limit the
To understand the value of fish as a food source
size of catches. Unfortunately, scientists now believe
■ To know how fishing methods increase yield
that initial quotas for some species were too high,
■ To understand how overfishing has reduced fish stocks
and even the reduced quotas now in force have not
■ To appreciate that the management of fish stocks allowed fish populations to recover. The fishermen
depends on scientific research
are tempted to catch more than their quota but
to throw back the smaller, less marketable fish.
Fish as a source of food
These fish are often damaged by capture and do not
Fish have been a valuable food source for humans
survive to reproduce.
for thousands of years. Fish are an excellent
source of protein and, depending on species, As with many situations, there are no clear-cut
of oils. Scientists are becoming more aware of answers. Fishermen understand that fish stocks
the value of fish oils in preventing some of the must be allowed to recover but are naturally anxious
'diseases of affluence', such as coronary heart about making a living. The scientists can only
disease (see page 106). It is very important advise, the governments must act on this advice!
that humans include certain oily compounds Restocking
(especially unsaturated fatty acids) in their diet, Fish can be bred in very large numbers in
and these oily compounds are extremely abundant enclosures, either in the sea or in lakes. These
in some fish species. fish can be grown to a size at which they can be
successfully released to replenish wild populations.
Steps taken to conserve fish stocks
Seine ('purse-seine') netting - the net is towed to the school
Education of herring by two boats. The fish are surrounded by the net and
Through knowledge of the growth pattern of the bottom of the 'purse' is sealed by pulling on the rope. The
individual fish, it is possible to study small groups net is slowly tightened so that the fish are concentrated in a
small volume of water - the immature fish have time to escape.
of fish to work out how long they take to reach The captured fish are lifted from the water using hand nets -
breeding age, what their maximum size will be this limits the damage to the fish and so reduces wastage.
120 mm mesh size catches mature herring but allows small cod
and haddock to escape .
Fish farming can provide food or may he used for restocking the wild.
Hanging net
,- - - - - ■ Keeps out aquatic predators such as otter and pike.
■ Keeps out other fish and soreduces competition for
t he pelleted food.
279
.
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
Poison dart frogs in Central America Tigers in Sumatra, Siberia and India Snow leopard in Pakistan and Nepal
a Loss of habitat, due to deforestation a Hunting for fur, bones, teeth and blood which a Hunting for fur, bones, teeth and
and drainage of wetlands. are used in Chinese traditional medicines. blood which are used in some
b A series of viral and fungal diseases. b Competition for land with villagers, who cannot traditional medicines.
afford to lose livestock to predation by the tigers. b Conflict with villagers, who cannot
Setting up protected areas, with
In some areas, tigers can pose a direct threat to afford to lose livestock to predation
buffer zones to prevent the spread
humans as they are such powerful predators. by the leopards.
of contagious diseases. Education
programmes which emphasise that Setting up protected areas such as fenced Snow leopard populations are carefully
amphibians are often a good sanctuaries, conservation areas and intensive monitored by cameras set on
indicator of the 'health' of our protection zones, especially in National Parks. established trails. Some animal
planet. Research into disease, and Trade in tiger products is banned by CITES. movements can also be tracked using
into the breeding success of these Tiger populations in the wild have fallen so radio collars. Government bodies
animals. dramatically that captive breeding (see page 277) provide financial compensation to
is now responsible for keeping up numbers of villagers, and set up education
most subspecies. programmes which show local people
the possible benefits of eco-tourism.
S Sewage treatment provides clean water by a combination of physical and biological methods
Effluent
.. \ . . /
Air Jets
Anaerobic digestion of sewage sludge involves several stages: IMethane produced during Key
1 A wide range of microbes hydrolyse: anaerobic digestion is burned to:
fats - fatty acids ■ power pumps and other
Physical methods
proteins - amino acids machinery in the plant
carbohydrates -
2 .. . and then produce methane.
sugars ■ raise the temperature in the
anaerobic digester to 55°C -
C Biological methods
If these processes are not carefully regulated (they are, for example, this kills pathogens and speeds
sensitive to pH changes) they become inefficient and very smelly! up the digestion process.
.
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
fermentation reactions
waste
Fast-growing tree species may provide renewable fuel
■ liquid fuels - alcohol and vegetable oil e.g. eucalyptus in the Democratic Republic of the Congo ...
■ gaseous fuel - biogas (a m etha ne/carb on
dioxide mixture).
The production of these biomass fuels is described Erect, regular growth habit means
easy cutting and storing.
in the diagrams on the right: this can help to reduce Rapid growth - 8 m in 3 years.
our use of fossil fuels, which are non-renewable. High resin/oil content means it is clean-
burning, giving out much heat.
® 1 What is a biomass fuel? What advantages might the ... and sweet chestnut from coppices in Kent may fuel local
power stations.
use of biomass fuels offer?
2 What are the environmental benefits of fast-growing
tree species? Sustainable forests
0 Look at the diagram opposite.
Using wood as fuel contributes to
a Suggest three products which could be sold, apart
from the alcohol produced. deforestation (see p age 270), but:
b Both amylase and cellulase are involved in the
■ selective felling (only a sm all prop ortion
preparation of the glucose feedstock for a
gasohol generator. Suggest the exact function of
of trees are cut down) is better th an clear
these enzymes. felling - less erosion a nd m ore wildlife
c How has genetic engineering helped the gasohol habitats
industry? ■ replanting can replace clear-felled trees,
d A typical American car travels 10 000 miles a year but tends to be a monoculture (see p age
at 15 m.p.g. This consumes the alcohol generated
284) and is a poor wildlife h abitat
by the fermentation of 5000 kg of grain. A human
■ education can explain the b enefits of
on a subsistence diet consumes about 200 kg of
grain per year. Comment on these figures. forests, particularly in terms of tourism.
4 Give two benefits that biogas generators offer to Local people can b e introduced to
rural communities in poor countries. alternative fuels (see biogas opposite).
5 Why are biogas generators built underground?
6 Why would it be inefficient to add disinfected
household waste to the biogas generator?
284
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
l
Enzymes are involved at several stages.
USA uses Corn Brazil uses Sugar cane ■ Waste products may be sold.
■ Less reliance on expensive petrochemicals,
l
Soak (then use Wash and
the liquid as a diminishing resource.
crush
cattle feed)
Grind - separates
germ, producing
Seed
corn oil
l Enzymes
amylases and
cellulases
l
Cane pulp
Separation - waste is
bagasse. This is burned,
giving energy for distillation
Starch Syrup
urification - impure
Enzymatic hydrolys~
sucrose solution
uses amylase \
molasses) -.cattle feed
/
fermentation
2C2HsOH + 2C02
(glucose) / (alcohol) \
Gas supply
Benefits of biogas to home What are ideal conditions?
■ Cheap - using surplus materials ■ Temperature of 20-30°(:
• Disposes of human waste fermentation rate doubles per 10°C rise
■ Reduces landfill problems
■ Anaerobic conditions:
■ Reduces use of other sources
oxygen is toxic to methanogenic bacteria
of power ■ Underground position ,.. low O/stable temperature
Discharged slurry
Inlet Outlet
used as manure
Ground level ~
Concrete- - - -- - --
inlet pipe
Input contains large 3m
molecules from plant
and animal waste.
methane }
+ Biogas
Several stages carried out by carbon dioxide
different bacteria
carbohydrates ,----> ◊ carbon dioxide
<Jo o □ (> +
water
285
.
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
Recycling
Recycling involves reusing waste products or materials which
would otherwise be thrown away. This includes reusing items in
their original form and sending materials away to special centres
where they can be melted down or pulped to act as raw materials
in industry.
Items that can be reused include:
■ glass milk or soft drink bottles
■ plastic shopping bags
■ paper that has only been written on one side
■ clothes
■ aluminium cans
■ plastic bottles
■ paper and card
■ scrap metal.
286
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
Recycling can make scarce resources last for longer, and can reduce
the energy requirements of industry. It takes only 5% of the energy
to make an aluminium can from recycled aluminium than from
aluminium ore. People and companies will only recycle, however, if:
■ their products are cheaper than if they don't use recycling
■ governments give subsidies for manufacturing products from
recycled materials.
s Recycling of paper
Paper is one of the easiest materials to recycle. It is collected from
our kerbside or recycling banks by local authorities and waste
management companies.
After the paper is collected there are several steps in the recycling
process.
■ First it is sorted, graded and delivered to a paper mill. As it is
sorted, contaminants such as plastic, metal, and other rubbish that
may have been collected with the paper are removed.
■ Once at the paper mill, it is added to water and then turned into
pulp.
■ The paper is then screened, cleaned and de-inked through a
number of processes until it is suitable for papermaking. Cleaning
and de-inking may use hazardous chemicals: hydrogen peroxide
is often used to help bleach the paper when dark inks are present.
■ Once the pulp has been rinsed, it is spread onto large flat racks,
and rollers press the water out of the pulp. As it dries, new paper
forms.
■ It is then ready to be made into new paper products such as
newsprint, cardboard, packaging, tissue and office items.
27%
natural
disasters 73%
86% 80%
27 %
result of
human
action 73%
The results of this investigation are shown in the
table below.
Both during and after the Second World War, f Suggest two important minerals required
fanners were encouraged to grow more food, by crop plants. State why each of them
with greater efficiency and at lower cost. is important. [4]
On one fann with small fields, removing 2 km of
hedgerow provided another 1. 5 hectares of arable 4 A scientist noticed that some plants were never
land and reduced by 35% the amount of time bothered by insects. He was interested in
needed to hatvest a field of wheat. whether the plants contained their own natural
Towards the end of the 20th century, the insecticide. He ground up the plants so that he
European Union was paying large subsidies to could collect the natural insecticide which he
farmers to store excess agricultural produce. thought was soluble in water.
Fanners are now encouraged by the European a Describe a technique the scientist might use
Union to grow less food. to separate the dissolved insecticide from
a State the highest average removal of hedges the crushed-up remains of the plant. [2]
in the UK before 1969. [ 1] He thought that the juice would be able
h If that rate of removal continued, suggest to kill insects and decided to try to find
i the likely effect on the variety of wild out whether spraying a greater volume of
animals and plants in the countryside [ 1] pesticide juice would kill larger numbers
ii the effect on the amount of arable land of insects.
available for farming. [ 1] h Suggest what his hypothesis would be, and
c Suggest why it is less important to gain
what prediction he might make. [2]
additional arable land now than during and To carry out this investigation, the scientist
immediately after the Second World War. [ 1] and his team of workers made up a number of
d More efficient farming often involves different concentrations of the natural pesticide
monoculture. and then sprayed the insecticide solutions onto
Suggest two advantages and two a series of plants. Each plant was of the same
disadvantages of monoculture. [ 4] species and each plant had 100 aphids (small
Read the following and then answer questions insects which feed on the phloem contents)
(e) and (f). feeding on it. The team kept all of the plants in
A Hedges provide an important habitat for the same room and later counted how many
animals which can help with pollination aphids were alive after 24 hours.
c Name the independent variable in this
and biological control.
B Hedges shade part of the crop which can investigation. [1]
reduce yields. d Name the dependent variable. [ 1]
C Hedges can provide a home for insect pests e Explain why the team of scientists believed
and rabbits. that the results were valid. [2]
D Hedges are an attractive feature in the The table below shows the results obtained.
countryside. Concentration
E Hedges make it more difficult to use of insecticide
0 5 10 15 20 25 30 40 50 100
modern fann machinery. / g per 1000
F Hedges can compete with crop plants for dm3
minerals and water. Number of
G Many farm workers are needed to maintain aphids alive 99 97 96 95 55 40 25 20 21 20
hedges properly. after 24 h
H Hedges provide a windbreak and shelter
f Draw a line graph of these results. [4]
and shade for farm animals.
g State the concentration of insecticide needed
I Hedges help to prevent topsoil blowing
to kill 50% of the aphids. [2]
away.
h Explain whether the results support the
J Hedges provide cover for gamebirds such
original prediction made by the scientist. [2]
as pheasants and partridges.
e Choose five statements from this list to
support a case for retaining hedges. [S]
289
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
5 Flatmill Lake is a lake in East Anglia in the UK. 6 The red squirrel is a small rodent which
Water flows into the lake from the River Bure, feeds largely on pine cones. Two ecologists
and the lake is surrounded by farmland which were interested in the conservation of the red
slopes down towards it. squirrel, and particularly in the reasons for its
decline in number. They studied the number of
0 2 km
deaths of red squirrels in a large sampling area.
The data in the table refer to the number of
deaths in one year.
Sewage Month Number of Month Number of
treatment works
deaths deaths
'----t--X
Jan 22 Jui 10
Feb 29 Aug 12
Mar 32 Sep 10
Apr 20 Oct 22
Norwich May 14 Nov 26
In recent years there has been a large increase Jun 17 Dec 36
in the concentration of nitrates and phosphate a Plot this data as a bar chart. [4]
in the waters of the lake. h Calculate the total number of deaths in this
a Suggest how these chemicals reached year. [1]
the lake. [2] C In which two months did most deaths
b High levels of nitrate and phosphate can occur? Suggest why. [2]
have unwelcome effects on the lake. Some of d The scientists believed that the maximum
these changes are described in the following population existed in August (the young
statements. are born in April-May). They sampled
State the correct order of these changes. the population, using the mark-recapture
A Nitrates and phosphates are minerals method, and obtained the following data.
essential for the growth of algae.
Number in first Number in Number of
B Fish die due to lack of dissolved oxygen.
sample, marked second sample marked animals
C Large amounts of oxygen are consumed and released in second
as populations of bacteria increase. sample
D Nitrates and phosphates pollute 100 80 25
the water.
Calculate the total population size at the time
E Water becomes green and cloudy as of the sample. [2]
populations of algae increase.
e The population of red squirrels in Britain
F Dissolved oxygen concentrations
has fallen rapidly over the last century.
fall rapidly.
They are protected under the Wildlife and
G Many algae die and provide nutrients for
Countryside Act, so cannot legally be killed
decay bacteria. [ 6]
by humans. Grey squirrels do not enjoy the
same protection. Suggest two measures
which could be taken to increase the
number of red squirrels. [2]
290
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
7 The table below shows estimates of the total a Plot these data in the form of a line graph.
amounts of various pollutants released into the Choose axes to display the information in
atmosphere during a single year in the USA. the way that best relates the abiotic factor to
the biotic factors.
Pollutant Mass/ million Percentage
h Suggest why the number of bacteria was
tonnes
high at O m.
carbon monoxide 190
c Explain the shape of the curve for algae.
nitrogen oxides 40 d How is it possible for fish numbers to fall to
sulfur oxides 50 zero and then recover?
hydrocarbons 50 e Describe the changes in the concentration of
particles e.g. carbon 30 oxygen dissolved in the water downstream
from the point of sewage entry.
a Calculate the percentage contribution of
f Explain what might have caused these
each of the pollutants. [2]
changes in oxygen concentration.
h Draw a bar chart to show the data. [4]
c Choose one pollutant from the table. State Number / arbitrary units of
one effect on human health and one effect Distance downstream I m Bacteria Algae Fish
on the environment of this pollutant. [2] 0 (point of sewage entry) 88 20 20
100 79 8 6
8 Sea otters eat fish, and fish eat small 200 74 7 1
crustaceans such as shrimps. The shrimps feed 300 60 21 0
by filtering algae from the water. 400 51 40 0
a Write out a food chain that links these 500 48 70 0
organisms. 600 44 83 0
h Pesticides are washed from nearby farmland 700 42 90 0
into rivers and then into the sea. Farmers 800 39 84 0
900 36 68 4
say that the concentration of the pesticides
1000 35 55 20
is too low to directly affect the otters.
Explain how the pesticides might still cause
the death of the otters.
9 Untreated human sewage should not enter
river water, but occasionally an overflow from
a water treatment plant occurs. The tables
below and to the right contain information
on the changes that occurred in river water
downstream from a sewage overflow.
Distance downstream I m Concentration of dissolved
oxygen / percentage of
maximum
0 (point of sewage entry) 95
100 30
200 20
300 28
400 42
500 58
600 70
700 80
800 89
900 95
1000 100
291
.
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
OBJECTIVES
■ To know the structure of a typical bacterial cell s
■ To know the requirements for bacterial growth
Bacteria are particularly useful in biotechnology
■ To know how bacteria reproduce and genetic engineering because:
■ To understand some of the ways in which bacteria ■ they reproduce very rapidly so scientists can build up large
populations very quickly
can be used in human activities
■ they can produce complex molecules, such as enzymes
and the hormone insulin
■ their genetic code is the same as that in more complex
Requirements of bacteria organisms (even humans!)
Bacteria have certain requirements that their • they have extra pieces of DNA - plasmids - which scientists
environment must provide. An understanding can use to carry genes from one cell to another
■ people are less worried about experiments on bacteria
of these requirements has been important in than on more familiar, larger, organisms such as mice,
biotechnology and in the control of disease. rabbits and dogs.
If the environment supplies these needs, the
bacteria can multiply rapidly by binary fission
(see below). In this process, each bacterium Understanding what bacteria need to reproduce can be
divides into two, then each of the two divides useful in :
again and so on, until very large populations ■ preventing food spoilage - see page 113
■ controlling infections
are built up. A bacterial colony can quickly ■ providing the best condit ions for growth of useful bacteria.
dominate its environment, making great
demands on food and oxygen, and perhaps
producing large quantities of 'waste' materials.
The generation time (time taken for each cell to divide into two)
Some of these waste materials can be useful to can be as little as 20 minutes under ideal conditions. One E. co/i
humans. For example, bacterial enzymes are cell in the human gut could theoretically become 2 72 cells in
used in a number of industrial processes. 24 hours - this number of cells weighs about 8000 kg!
DNA replication
This can be so
rapid that a
292
bacterial population
can grow very quickly
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
Nutrient input -
the microorganisms require:
■ an energy source - usually Constant temperature water jacket -
carbohydrate the temperature is controlled so that it is
■ growth materials - amino acids high enough to promote enzyme activity
(or ammonium salts which can be but not so high that enzymes and other
converted to amino acids) for proteins in the microbes are denatured.
protein synthesis.
Heating/cooling ~
water out
--- Probes monitor conditions such as pH,
temperature and oxygen concentration.
Sterile conditions are essential. Information is sent to computer control
The culture must be pure and systems which correct any changes to
all nutrients/equipment sterile to: maintain the optimum conditions for
■ avoid competition for fermentation.
expensive nutrients
■ limit the danger of disease-
causing organisms contaminating
the product.
Heating/cooling
water in
q ---,
293
.
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
@© r- lactose
©© . .
• • •
,+--- -Immobilised lactase
(breaks dow n lactose)
or onto fibres.
~
enzyme is • . .
t hen packed · : • : · Some people
into a column. •• become ill if t hey
consume lactose - they
Pharmaceuticals Analysis
The enzyme catalase is used Dip-sticks such as Clinistix® and
in wound dressings. Catalase Albustix® use enzymes to detect
converts hydrogen peroxide biological compounds in mixtures.
in the dressing to oxygen and The biological compound is
water. Oxygen speeds up healing oxidised to a product which
and inhibits dangerous, anaerobic causes a colour change in a dye.
bacteria such as the species which
causes gas gangrene.
Pad at the end of stick contains
Glucose
enzyme+ dye Glucose Changed
+ dye dye
oxidase
This is used by people with diabetes to test blood or urine for the
presence of glucose (see page 149).
c;; 1
A lipase from fungi helps to
make chocolate flow to cover
Economical biscuits and sweets !
conditions
Q
l
Enzyme + substrate Enzyme + products
®
1 Read the following passage.
An enzyme implant has successfully reduced the level of particles of the fatty substance, cholesterol, in the blood of
rabbits by 40% within 70 minutes. Scientists have developed a way of implanting the enzyme PLA2 into the body
without affecting the cholesterol needed in cell membranes. The enzyme is immobilised inside thin hollow fibres. Pores
in the walls of the fibre are large enough for cholesterol particles to diffuse through, but too small for blood cells to
enter. The enzyme breaks down the cholesterol, and the products are rapidly taken up by liver cells and removed from
the bloodstream.
The scientists are cautious about using enzyme therapy in humans. 'We need to know exactly what happens to the
products from the cholesterol in the body', says the head of the laboratory that developed the technique. 'Several drugs
already on the market can safely be used to lower cholesterol levels. However, an implant of the immobilised enzyme
PLA2 could be easily inserted and could last for years'.
a Explain the advantage of lowering the level of the fatty substance, cholesterol, in the blood.
b Suggest how the enzyme might be immobilised inside the fibres.
c Suggest why it is an advantage to immobilise the enzyme inside hollow fibres.
d The enzyme PLA2 occurs naturally in humans. Explain why the enzyme could not be used as an implant if it did not
occur naturally in the human body.
295
21.2 Humans use enzymes from microorganisms
Because detergents, especially bath soaps, are generally formulated to degrade main ly oil and grease, protein-based stains
have traditionally been among the hardest to remove.
Casein (m il k protein) easily binds to a blue dye. Small pieces of fabric can be stained by soaking in a solution of dyed casein.
The dye separates from the casein if the protein is broken down by the action of an enzyme.
Suggest how you would compare the effect of a bacterial protease and a commercial detergent on a protein-based stain .
Assume that you can use a colorimeter (an instrument that can measure the absorption of light by a solution).
Colorimeter:
light is passed
◊
94
through solution
I in cuvette. Light
transmitted (not
absorbed) is
....______, sensed and value
Bathing solution shown on a
(water + released digital display.
dye) is transferred
to a cuvette.
Pectinase is an enzyme that cata lyses the breakdown of 5 After 25 minutes, filter the ju ice from each boiling tube
pectin, a component of the cell wall in fruits such as apples separately, as shown in the diagram.
and oranges. Pectinase is used commercially because, by 6 Record the volumes of ju ice collected at 1-minute
enzymatically breaking down the cell wall, pectinase releases intervals until no more juice is collected.
the juice from with in the cells. Pectinase can also be used to
'clear' the extracted ju ice. Filter paper containing
apple pulp plus enzyme solution
Procedure or apple pu lp plus distilled water.
1 Chop the apples into cubes that are rough ly 5 mm on SAFETY
each side. Do not drin k the ju ice,
2 Weigh 50 g of chopped apple into each of eight boili ng because the pectinase
tubes. solution is much more concentrated
t han wou ld be used in commercial
3 A solution of pectinase will be supplied to you. Add
2 cm 3 of pectinase solution to four of the boili ng tubes,
..
-
production of fruit ju ice .
Record your results in a suitable table, showing the d Suggest how you could extend the investigation to
volume of juice collected after a 5-minute period at each study pectinase in other fruits.
of the four different temperatures.
Plot a suitable graph of your results.
Extension
Analysis e Describe a chemical test for lactose (a reducing
a State the independent and dependent variables in sugar).
th is investigation. f Suggest how you would show that lactase is
b State the reason for including tubes with distilled necessary for the breakdown of lactose.
water in this investigation.
c Explain why temperature affects the activity of
pectinase.
®
2 The image below shows a photomicrograph of a c State three reasons why enzymes are useful for
reproducing bacterium. industrial processes. [3]
d State two reasons why immobilised enzymes
are used in industrial processes. [2]
3 The enzyme glucose oxidase can be
incorporated into a test strip used to test for the
presence of glucose in biological fluids. The
enzyme can convert glucose to an acid which then
changes the colour of a dye if the sugar is present.
a Suggest the names of two biological fluids
which can be tested in this way. [2]
Magnification x25 000
b State the name of the medical condition which
a Calculate the actual length of a single
could result in high levels of glucose in these
bacterium.
biological fluids. [1]
Give your answer in micrometres (µm). Show
c State which two of the following foods are
your working. [3]
most likely to cause a rise in glucose
b Bacteria may be used to produce enzymes concentration in these fluids:
useful to humans. butter, pasta, lean meat, breakfast cereal, milk
Look at the table below. Match each enzyme to chocolate. [2]
a process useful to humans.
Write the letter and number to show your
answer, for example, a-3.
Enzyme Process
a protease 1 breakdown of starch in water washed
from laundries
b pectinase 2 removal of fatty stains from clothing
c lactase 3 softening of leather for jackets and
handbags
d amylase 4 clearing of fragments of fruit from
fruit juice
e lipase 5 preparation of milk for patients with
milk sugar intolerance
297
.
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
~--motor
steam inlet = = = = ~
cold water-----~
jacker
cold water=(S)=~
inlet
air inlet
2 Wine can be produced on a small scale using Explain how aerobic respiration is prevented
the apparatus shown below. in this apparatus. [1]
3 Mycoprotein is a single cell protein which can
fermentation lock
be used as a substitute for chicken or for beef.
The table below shows the composition of
burgers made from beef and from mycoprotein.
l~ I
g
Bacteria containing the desirable
gene are selected and then cultured
in a nutrient medium to provide a
large population capable of producing
the desired gene product.
I
- - + - - - - - - Selected bacteria are cultured in
a fermenter or bioreactor under
optimum pH, temperature
and nutrient levels.
Product
l
After some processing, for example to remove the bacterial cells for recycling, the product is extremely pure and relatively inexpensive.
Important examples of such gene products are:
■ insulin (required for the treatment of diabetes)
■ human growth hormone
■ factor VIII (blood clotting factor for haemophilia)
■ BGH is an important animal hormone used to speed up the growth of beef cattle (see page 265).
• Genetic engineering (recombinant DNA technology) depends on enzymes and the culture of microorganisms 301
.
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
Empty virus
Virus takes up
coat to act a~ Virus infects
healthy gene.
gene vector. ~ 'diseased' cell
and releases
~~
healthy gene.
Healthy copy
c::c =====I====◊
of gene
Cell can now make
Cystic fibrosis is a good candidate for
protein product,
gene therapy because: and no longer has
■ the healthy gene has been identified disease .
and is easily obtained
■ the diseased tissue in the lungs is easy
to reach via trachea and bronchi Healthy
■ the coat of an influenza virus can be gene 'repairs'
used as a gene vector. diseased cell.
302
ORGANISMS AND THEIR ENVIRONMENT
' ~
causes acute infection of the liver. genetic material
of virus.
♦-··-♦
•♦ -
. . . . . . . . Yeast cells are removed from
Anti-H epatitis B ~ the medium. They can be recycled
h._ vacc in e ---1 for further antigen Antigen gene from virus is
incorporated into the DNA
'-.. __ j production. ' of a yeast cell.
I
Yeast cells grow and multiply
in culture medium containing Yeast cells manufacture virus antigen.
all nutrients at correct pH They do not need it so they secrete it
and temperature . into their growth medium.
.A Genetic engineering provides a safe vaccine against hepatitis B, given to people likely to be
exposed to this virus (such as a surgeon who might come into contact with patients' blood)
304
1 The diagram below shows the main stages 2 A vaccine against hepatitis B can be made by
in transferring the human insulin gene to a genetic engineering (see page 292).
bacterium. a In this process:
human cell i State which part of the virus is
which transferred to a yeast cell. [ 1]
0 secretes
insulin ii State which part of the virus is produced
by the yeast cell. [1]
plasmid bacterium
DNA in nucleus h Before genetic engineering was developed,
vaccines contained viruses that had been
human insulin
gene (DNA)
heated or treated chemically to stop them
Stage 1 reproducing. Whole virus particles were
present in the vaccine.
Explain why a genetically engineered
vaccine is safer than a vaccine made directly
bacterial plasmid
containing human from hepatitis B virus. [3]
Stage 2
insulin gene
3 The following table lists events from the
identification of a human gene coding for a
plasmid reintroduced
into bacterium hormone "X" to the commercial production of
hormone "X".
305
.
CHARACTERISTICS AND CLASSIFICATION OF LIVING ORGANISMS
The basis of scientific subjects is experimental: Candidates may be required to do the following:
hypotheses are tested to establish theories and ■ record readings from apparatus
observations and measurements made to provide ■ describe, explain or comment on experimental
the factual background to science. Examiners arrangements and techniques
believe that it is important that an assessment of a ■ complete tables of data
student's knowledge and understanding of biology ■ draw conclusions from observations and/or
should contain a practical component. from information given
Schools' circumstances (e.g. the availability of ■ interpret and evaluate observations and
resources) differ greatly, so two alternative ways of experimental data
examining the relevant assessment are provided by ■ plot graphs and/or interpret graphical
Cambridge Assessment International Education information
(CAIE). The two alternatives are: ■ identify sources of error and suggest possible
■ Paper 5 - practical test improvements in procedures
■ Paper 6 - alternative to practical (written ■ plan an investigation, including suggesting
paper). suitable techniques and apparatus.
The following points should be noted for both types Paper 6: Alternative to practical
of practical assessment: This paper is designed to test candidates'
■ the same proportion of marks is available - familiarity with laboratory practical procedures.
20% of the subject total Questions may be set requiring the candidates to:
■ the same practical skills are to be learned and
■ follow carefully a sequence of instructions
developed
■ use familiar, and unfamiliar, techniques to
■ the same benefits to theoretical understanding
record observations and make deductions
come from all practical work.
from them
Paper 5: Practical test ■ recall simple physiological experiments,
The CAIE specification states: e.g. tests for food substances, the use of a
Exercises may be set requiring the candidates to: potometer and the use of hydrogencarbonate
indicator, litmus and Universal Indicator paper
■ follow carefully a sequence of instructions
■ recognise, observe and record familiar, and
■ use familiar, and unfamiliar, techniques to
unfamiliar, biological specimens
record observations and make deductions
■ make a clear line drawing from a photograph
from them
( or other visual representation) of a specimen,
■ perform simple physiological experiments,
indicate the magnification of the drawing and
e.g. tests for food substances and the use of
label, as required
hydrogencarbonate indicator, litmus and
■ perform simple arithmetical calculations
Universal Indicator paper
■ record readings from apparatus
■ use a scalpel or a razor blade, forceps, scissors
■ describe, explain or comment on experimental
and mounted needles skilfully
arrangements and techniques
■ use a hand lens of not less than x 6
■ complete tables of data
magnification to recognise, observe and record
■ draw conclusions from observations and/or
familiar, and unfamiliar, biological specimens
from information given
■ make a clear line drawing of a specimen
■ interpret and evaluate observations and
provided, indicate the magnification of the
experimental data
drawing and label, as required
■ plot graphs and/or interpret graphical
■ perform simple arithmetical calculations.
information
306
PRACTICAL BIOLOGY
■ identify sources of error and suggest possible that might appear in either the practical test
improvements in procedures or the alternative to practical. These are listed in
■ plan an investigation, including suggesting the table below, and should give you a great deal
suitable techniques and apparatus. of help in dealing with whichever of these papers
Throughout this book there are a number of is used in your practical assessment.
examples of the type of experiment or exercise
Conditions for germination 16.5 Gives references to enzymes, and the need
for energy
307
PRACTICAL BIOLOGY
Jl
volume of liquids.
The other very important measuring device in the laboratory is a balance (weighing machine).
0
apparatus in place. This reduces the risk of
dangerous spills. This is not generally drawn. If the
clamp is merely to support a piece of appartus, it is
usually represented by two crosses as shown.
L ■
other apparatus (e.g. a liquid in a test tube) or for
directly heating solids.
308
u heating liquids.
LJ
PRACTICAL BIOLOGY
Chemical reagents
In accordance with the COSHH ( Control of Substances Ha zardous to Health) regulations
operative in the UK, a hazard appraisal of the list below has been carried out. The following
codes are used where relevant:
C = corrosive substance; F = highly flammable substance; H = harmful or irritating
substance; 0 = oxidizing substance; T = toxic substance
~ iodine in potassium iodide solution (iodine solution) Detection of starch 2.1, 4.2, 6.1, 6.2
:&] Benedict's solution (or an alternative such as Fehling's) Detection of a reducing sugar, such as glucose 4.2
[61 ethanol/methylated spirit For dissolving lipids in testing for the presence of lipids. Also 4.2, 6.1
used to remove chlorophyll from leaves during starch
testing.
hydrogencarbonate indicator (bicarbonate indicator) Detect changes in carbon dioxide concentration, for example 6.1, 6.2, 6.6, 11.3
in exhaled air following respiration
cobalt chloride paper Detects changes in water content 8.4
pH indicator paper or Universal Indicator solution or Changes in pH during reactions such as digestion of fats to
pH probes fatty acids and glycerol
litmus paper Qualitative detection of pH
glucose Change in water potential of solutions
sodium chloride Change in water potential of solutions
aluminium foil or black paper Foil can be used a heat reflector: black paper as a 6.1, 6.6, 6.7
light absorber
a source of distilled or deionised water Change in water potential of solutions. Also used in making 4.2, 6.7, 21.2
up mineral nutrient solutions.
eosin/red ink To follow the pathway of water absorbed by plants 8.1
limewater A liquid absorbent for carbon dioxide, for example in 11.3
exhaled air
~ potassium hydroxide Removes carbon dioxide from the atmosphere, for example 11.3
during experiments on conditions for photosythesis
sodium hydrogencarbonate (sodium bicarbonate) Very mild alkali: use for adjusting pH of solutions for enzyme
activity
309
petroleum jelly (or similar) Blocks pores such as stomata, and so prevents water loss 8.4, 11.3
PRACTICAL BIOLOGY
Measurement of variables
In m a ny investigations, biologists need to m easure variable quantities
such as volume, temperature, m ass and time. It is very important to be
able to read scales accurately and to choose th e correct units for the
quantities that have b een m easured. Some of the common m easuring
equipment used in biology laboratories is shown below.
( 80
----
The scale is worked out by
70
checking how long the liquid column is
60 f irstly in melting ice and secondly in
so
boiling water.
40
An electronic t hermometer
and probe. Equipment like
this w ill be necessary if a I ~20.9 I .._
scientist needs to measure
temperature above 100°( !READ! -
v ii
or below 0°C.
Temperature probe / -
■ ■
102.4g ■
312.Sg ■
310
PRACTICAL BIOLOGY
BEAKER MEASURING When using a measuring cylinder, stand the Make sure that you read the
It is not accurate CYLINDER measuring cylinder on a level bench, so that level carefully. You may notice
to use a beaker the liquid is level. that the surface of the fluid
because the scale is curved; this is called the
is not fine enough. meniscus.
1 kg= 1000 g
311
PRACTICAL BIOLOGY
~
to draw conclusion s from
the resu lts.
~ Present numerical dat a
■ in decimal form
Do not leave blanks:
use - for a missing
■ to t he same number value and 0 for zero.
of decimal places
■ as t rue numbers,
e.g. 0.7 not .7
• Results are recorded in a table d uring the experiment. Give an informative title,
such as: The effect of temperature on the activity of cata!ase.
313
P R A C T I C r~. L 3 I O L. 0 G Y
Mathematical skills
Accuracy, precision and reliability
Accurate data can be obtained by: Significant figures and decimal places
■ repeating measurements to calculate ■ Significant figures refer to the number
a mean of important single digits in a value, often
■ using a different measuring instrument, a measurement. All non-zero digits are
and checking that readings are the same considered significant. For example, 37
■ using measuring instruments with finer has two significant figures (3 and 7), while
gradations. 567.89 has five significant figures (5, 6, 7, 8
and 9).
■ Zeros to the left of the significant figures
Precise data can be obtained by: are not significant. For example, 0.00048
■ using measuring instruments with finer has two significant figures: 4 and 8.
gradations - use a stopwatch to measure ■ Decimal places refer to the number of
reaction times (not the clock on the digits after a decimal point in a number. For
classroom wall) or a pH meter rather than example, 34.65 is a number to two decimal
litmus paper. places.
It is important that any manipulated
Errors and anomalies data (for example, a calculated mean)
■ Errors can be random (usually the result is presented to the same number of
of poor technique - not carrying out the significant figures as the input data (for
experiment consistently) or systematic example, a series of measurements of
(consistent technique, but repeating the the same quantity).
error such as inaccurate reading of a A common error in answering numerical
scale). questions is to rely on a calculator - this
■ Anomalous results do not fit in with may give an answer to six significant figures
the pattern of the other results. A large when the measurements were only made to
sample size will allow anomalous results two significant figures, often because of the
to be easily spotted in the data set. They limited scales of the measuring instruments.
can then be discarded, leading to a more
accurate calculation of the mean.
314
PRACTICAL BIOLOGY
Histogram
■ Used when plotting the distribution of continuous data.
■ Shows range of continuous variable (height of
buttercup in the example on the right) on y-axis and
number/percentage within range (number in this
example) on x-axis.
■ Each range is drawn in a block. Blocks are drawn in
order of increasing or decreasing data.
■ Blocks should never overlap, e.g. 25-29, 30-34, 35-39 is
correct but 25-30, 30-35, 35-40 is not.
■ The blocks should be of the same width.
■ The blocks should be touching.
Continuous variables are usually the result of the
combined effects of genes and the environment.
70
'i
g' 60
...
0
Cl 50
Bar chart
-......
E
C
GI
40
■ Drawn when one of the variables is
non-numerical.
C 30
0
V
■ The non-numerical variable (type of
u 20 fnrlt in this example) is on the x-axis
and the numerical variable (vitamin C
content in this example) on the y-axis.
■ The blocks should be the same width,
and can be in any order.
type of fruit tested ■ The blocks should not be touching - the
blocks are not related to one another.
For all forms of graphs and charts: Categoric variables are usually the result of
■ label axes with quantity the effects of genes alone.
■ add units if the data is numerical
■ separate the quantity and units with a solidus(/), e.g.
vitamin concentration / mg per 100 g of tissue (never use a
solidus as part of the unit, e.g. mg/100 g of tissue).
Pie chart
■ Data displayed as proportions of the
vitamins and minerals whole data set.
protein
■ The proportions are displayed as
sectors of a circle (which represents the
whole data set).
■ The sectors should begin at 'noon', i.e.
the twelve o'clock position.
■ The sectors should be drawn in rank
order, with the largest first.
■ Charts should preferably not contain
more than six sectors.
An example would be the proportions of
carbohydrate _ __J
- - - water the different components of a meal.
315
abiotic factors 240,241, 260-1 biochemical tests 38-9 plants 10,22,23, 33, 88, 89 immune response 99, 112,
acid rain 52, 270, 271 biochemistry basics 36-7 central nervous system (CNS) 154, 118-19
active transport 34, 89, 122 biodegradable waste 114 158-61 inherited conditions 111,
adaptation to environment 2, 10-11, 14, biodiversity 265, 276, 280 centromeres 207, 212 116, 222-3
93, 177,230-1,232-5 biogas 114,284,285 cervix 190,194,200 population growth 260
adrenal glands 140, 167, 168 biological oxygen demand (BOD) 274, characteristics of living organisms 2-3, prevention 112-14, 175,
adrenaline 132,148,163,167,168 275,279,282,283 18 203,263
adult stem cells 214, 216, 217 biomass fuels 284-5 CHD see coronary heart disease responsibilities 114--15,
aerobic respiration 24, 46, 106, 123--6, bioreactors 292,293, 301 chemical reagents 38-9, 309 203
184,251,274,283 biotechnology 292-305 chlorophyll 10, 23, 46-8, 51, 52, 59, 93 sexually transmitted infec-
age structure of population 263 chloroplasts 16, 22, 23, 46, 50, 51 tions 203
biotic factors, population growth 260-1
agriculture 53-4, 58-9, 89, 173, 264-70, cholera 17, 69, 73,110,112,120,282 smoking effects 134--7
birds 14, 15,242--4, 266,276
274--7 cholesterol 63, 70, 106, 295 disinfectants 175,251
birth 200, 202 DNA (deoxyribonucleic acid) 6, 23, 37,
AIDS/HIV 99, 110, 112, 203, 263 bleeding 116, 117, 147 chordates 6, 14--15
albinism 222 99,208-11,300-5
blood chromosome mutations 196, 230 Doll, Richard 136-7
alcohol (ethanol) 38, 47, 82, 98, 132, analysis 99 chromosomes 23, 207-9,212-13,
285,298 218-19,224 dominant alleles 219-23, 225
circulatory system 96-109 dormancy of seeds 184,185,277
algae 16, 59,244,274,275 clotting 98, 116, 225, 301 chyme 73, 77, 78
alimentary canal 72-80 cilia/ciliated cells 26, 116, 129, 135, 194 drought 69, 268
constituents 97 drugs
alleles 218-23, 225, 301 circulatory system 96-109
fighting disease 97, 98, effect on nervous system
allergies 111, 131 116-18 classification keys 4--5, 7, 14, 21
altitude effects on lungs 101, 129, 132 155
gas exchange in lungs 129 classification of living and non living see also alcohol; nicotine
alveoli 128-31, 135 glucose levels 148-9 things 2-3, 18
amino acids 37, 63, 77, 81,210 clones 173,176,177 duodenum 73, 77, 79
groups 223,228
amniotic fluid 196, 197 homeostasis 144, 148-9 CNS see central nervous system
amphibians 14, 281 colon 70, 73, 80 ecological sampling 246-9, 260, 277
blood cells 97-9 economic development, more and Jess
amylase 40, 41, 76, 78, 79,251,285,296 see also red blood cells; colon/bowel cancer 65, 70 developed countries 69, 70, 106, 136,
anaemia 64, 70, 99, 192 white blood cells colour blindness 224, 225 201,263,268-9
anaerobic respiration 124-5, 282,283, blood pressure 70,101,136,198 communities of organisms 241, 242 ecosystems 240-58
285,298 blood vessels 100-3 competition 234, 260, 262 education 203,269,277,278,281,284
angiosperms 10-11 BOD see biological oxygen demand reducing 13, 174, 181, 184, effectors, nervous system 154, 155,
animal cells 22, 23, 26-7, 33 body mass/weight 68-9, 132, 198 242,264 157-9
animals body temperature 15, 122, 145-7 concentration gradients 30, 32, 34 egestion 72, 78
captive breeding 277 bolus of food 73, 74, 76 see also water potential electrical impulses, nerves 26, 122, 155,
classification 12-15 bottle feeding 201 gradient 157,159,160,163
eating plants 46, 57 bowels see colon; intestines conception 194, 195, 202 embryonic stem cells 214,215,217
endangered species 276, brain 154, 156, 157, 158-9 condensation reactions 36, 37 embryos
277, 280-1 breastfeeding 67, 70,119,200,201 conservation 4, 276-81 human 188, 194-6,214
farming practices 265 constipation 65, 70, 73 plant 182--4
breathing 130-2
food chains and webs bronchial tree 128, 129 control centre in homeostasis 145, 146 emphysema 117, 135
242-6 controls in experiments 39, 312 emulsification of fats 78, 79
invertebrates 12-13 control systems in animals 154--69
calcium in diet 64, 70 emulsion test 38
livestock farming 166, 173, coronary heart disease (CHD) 70, 106-7,
265 cambium 87, 212 endangered species 276, 280
111, 135, 149, 278
selective breeding 236 cancer 65, 70,111, 135-7,231,272 endocrine system 154, 166-9
coronavirus/COVID-19 18, 68, 110, 111
tissues and organs 27 capillaries 96, 100-2 see also hormones
coughing 130,135,156 endoplasmic reticulum 24, 211
transport systems 96-109 carbohydrates cuticle of plants 10, 50, 51, 91, 93,303
vertebrates 14-15 in the diet 62, 63 endothermic animals 15, 146
cytoplasm 8, 9, 17, 22--4
anthers 179-81 digestion 76, 78 energy
antibiotics 112, 174--5, 203, 234, 265, metabolism 36, 37 active transport 34
Darv.rin, Charles 232
279 tests 39, 47 ecological pyramids 246-7
data collection 246-9
antibodies 117-19, 200 types 37, 63 flow through ecosystems
data handling 313 242-7
antigens 111, 116-19, 304 see also glucose; glycogen; deamination 81, 140
antiseptics 175, 251 maltose; starch; sucrose from food 62, 63, 66-9, 70
carbon cycle 57, 252-3 decomposition 114, 242-3, 250-5 from sun 46, 122, 242-3,
anus 72, 73 defaecation 72, 73, 78
carbon dioxide 247,256,257
aorta 100,101,104,106 deficiency diseases 63, 64, 69, 70, 74,
carbon cycle 252-3 heat 122
aquatic environments 59, 93, 244--5, 111,201,263,268
264, 274--5 entering leaf 50 living processes 3, 6 7, 122
deforestation 266-7, 270, 276, 280, 284 respiration 122-6
arteries 96, 100-1 forming carbonic acid 56, dehydration of body 73, 113, 142, 201
artificial baby milk 201 140 storage molecules 23, 57,
denaturation of enzymes 40-1, 52, 77, 68,123
artificial hormones 168 from aerobic respiration 140,146,147
56,123, 126-8 transducers 46, 160
artificial (inorganic) fertilisers 58, 255, desertification 270,271,276
264,275 from burning fossil fuels energy balance 68-70
52,252-3,270-1 development of embryo/fetus 196, 199 environment 240-305
artificial insemination 195, 236, 265 development level of countries 69, 70,
gas exchange in lungs 128, adaptation to 2, 10-11, 14,
artificial kidney 142-3 129, 131 106, 136,201,263,268-9 93,177, 230,232-5
artificial selection 236-7 in greenhouses 54 diabetes 99,119,149,216,295
asexual reproduction 176-7, 237, 292 biotic and abiotic factors
hydrogencarbonate indica- diaphragm 128-30, 156 240,241
assimilating products of digestion 72, tor 56, 127 diarrhoea 73, 110, 113, 142, 263 carbon cycle 252-3
80-2 dicotyledons 10, 11, 183
photosynthesis 46-7, 51, causes of disease 111
autonomic nervous system 158, 159 52,54, 56, 57 diet effects on breathing 132
autotrophic nutrition 10, 23, 46, 52, transport in blood 97, 98, balanced 62-5
57,62 effects on phenotype 229
100, 102, 132 coronary heart disease 70, human impacts 114-15,
auxin 171-2 carbon monoxide 132,135,198,270 106,278 244,266-75
carnivores 5-6, 235, 240, 242-6, 260, deficiencies 63, 64, 69, 70, nitrogen cycle 254-5
babies 63, 200-2 273,281 74, 111,201,263, 268 positive human effects
bacteria carpel 179,182,183 dental decay 75 276-91
antibiotics 112, 174--5, 203, carriers of inherited conditions 222, energy intake and demand water cycle 256-7
234,265,279 223,225 68-9 see also ecosystems
biotechnology 292-3, carrying capacity 260-2 pregnant women 67, 198
300-1 environmental resistance 260-1
catalysts see enzymes dietary fibre 62, 65, 70, 73, 76, 78, 298 enzymes 40-2
characteristics 17, 292 cell division 122, 206, 209, 212-16, 296 diffusion 30-1, 89, 96, 102
decomposers 242,250-1 clinical use 149, 295
cells 22-9 digestion 63, 72, 76-9 decomposition 251
dental decay 75 enzymes 40 diploid cells 176,182,213,218,219
disease causing 73, 110, digestion 76-9
movement of substances in disease 110-21 experiments 312-13
112-13 and out 30-5 antibiotics 112, 174--5, 203,
eutrophication 274, 275 factors affecting activity
optimum conditions 144 234,265,279 40-1
genetic engineering 300-1 structure 8, 17, 22, 23 blood analysis 99
industrial use 292-3 industrial production and
cell surface membranes 22, 23, 30-5, body's defences 97, 98, use 285, 292,294--7, 300,301
natural bactericides 116 102 116-19 mechanism of action 42
nitrogen cycle 254, 255 cellulose 10, 23, 37, 57, 65, 78, 88 bottle-fed babies 201 epidemiological studies 136-7
waste digestion 283, 285 cell walls classification 110, 111 epidermis of plants 27, 50, 51, 87, 93
base pairing 208-11 bacteria 17 epidemiological studies epiglottis 77, 156
bile 73, 78, 79 136-7
316 binary fission 8, 292
fungi 8
fish farming 279
equilibrium 30, 32--4, 261
erythrocytes see red blood cells genetic code 210 immune response 99, 112, 118-19
ethanol (alcohol) 38, 47, 82, 98, 132, genetic engineering 54, 237, 273, immunisation (vaccination) 110-11, natural (organic) fertilisers for plants
285,298 300-5 114, 119, 263, 304 58,254,255,283
eutrophication 59, 264, 274-5 genotype and phenotype 219-23, implantation of embryo 193-5 natural selection 232-5
see also biological oxy- 229-31 infectious diseases 110-19 negative feedback see feedback
gen demand geotropism 170 infertility treatments 195, 202 control
evaporation germinating seeds 126,172,178, ingestion 72, 74-5 nephrons 140,141
bysun 256,257,271 184-5 inheritance 111, 206-27 nerves 26,122, 154-7, 159,160,163
cooling body 146, 147, global warming/climate change 111, insecticides 86, 264, 273 nervous system 154-65
256 268,269,271,274,276 insects 12, 13,110, 179-81, 303 neurones 26, 154-7
deforested soil 26 7 glucagon 148, 167 insulin 119, 148-9, 167, 300-1 neurotransmitters 63, 155, 209
see also transpiration glucose 38 intercostal muscles 128-30, 156 nicotine 134, 135, 197
evolution 2, 4, 10, 159, 219, 232-5, homeostatic control in intestines 70, 73, 78-80 nitrates, plant requirements 52, 57-9
262 body 148-9
introduced species 244, 276 nitrogen cycle 254-5
excretion 2, 3, 72, 78, 81, 140-1 photosynthesis 46, 47, non-biodegradable waste 114,273,
51,57 invertebrate animals 12-13
exercise 67-9, 124, 125, 132 286
respiration 63 in vitro fertilisation 195
experimental method 48-9, 312-13 involuntary actions 156, 158, 159 non-infectious diseases 110, 111,
external digestion 4, 5, 9 test 39 119,131
glycerol 37, 40, 63, 78, 80, 251 iron in diet 64, 69, 70, 192, 198
see also saprotrophic irritability (sensitivity) 2, 3 nuclear power plants/nuclear weap-
nutrition glycogen 23, 36, 37, 63, 68, 148 ons 272
extinction 267, 277, 280 goblet cells 80, 129 nucleic acids 36, 37
eyes/vision 116, 161-3, 225 greenhouse cultivation 53-5 kidneys 140--4 see also DNA; RNA
greenhouse gases/effect 52, 265, kwashiorkor 63,69, 103
nucleotide base pairing 208-9
faeces 72, 73 270-1 nucleus of cells 16, 22, 23, 207
fair tests 49, 312 see also global warming laboratory equipment 308
nutrient cycles 250-5
famine 69, 177, 268-9 growth and development 2, 3, 196, labour and birth 200 nutrients
199, 212 lactation see breastfeeding
fatigue in muscles 105, 124 eutrophication of water
fats/fatty acids 37, 62, 63, 68, 78-80, growth hormones 166, 167, 279, 301 lactic acid 106, 124, 125 274-5, 279
146 growth of populations 260--4, 292 Lamarck, Jean Baptiste 234 plant minerals 46, 57-9
feedback, positive 274-5 growth substances (auxins) 171-2 larynx 129, 189 nutrition 2, 3
feedback control (negative feedback) guard cells 50 leaf structure 50-1 autotrophic 10, 23, 46,
blood glucose levels 148 gut see alimentary canal leukaemia 99,215,267, 272 52, 57,62
body temperature 145-7 lifestyle risks 106-7, 111, 198 converting food to us-
endocrine system 166, habitat loss 267, 276, 281, 284 light availability, population growth able molecules 72-82
167 habitats 241, 277 260 definitions 72
homeostasis 145-8 haemoglobin 26, 64, 97, 129, 135, light energy, photosynthesis 46, 49, heterotrophic 4, 5, 23,
211, 223, 230 50-5, 122,242-3 46, 57,62
population size 261
water balance 140, 143 haemophilia 116, 225, 301 light sensitivity 160-3, 170-1 human 62-85
feedback inhibition 168, 193, 202 haploid cells 176, 182, 190, 213, limiting factors 52-4, 261, 274 ideal diet 62-3
fermentation 174, 284, 285, 292-3, 218-20 Linnaeus, Carolus 6 providing organic mol-
298,301 heart 70, 96, 101, 104-7, 132, 135, lipase 40, 78, 79,251,295-6 ecules 36
fertilisation 176, 178 149,278 lipids 36-8, 57,62,63, 78-80 saprotrophic 8, 9, 17,
human reproduction heat energy 41,122,123, 146,256-7 liver 73, 81-2, 144,148 250-1
188,194,195,202 heat-temperature relationship 146 lungs 101,117, 128-37
plant reproduction herbicides (weed killers) 52, 173, lymph/lymph vessels 80, 102, 103 obesity 68, 70, 149
182-3 264,303 lymph nodes 103, 118 oesophagus 73, 76, 77
random assortment of herbivores 242-3, 246 lymphocytes 97, 98,103, 118-19, 203 oestrogen 166,167,189,192,193,
alleles 219, 220, 231 hermaphrodite plants 178, 180 198,200
restoring diploid number heterotrophic nutrition 4, 5, 23, 46, magnesium ions 46, 52, 59, 88 oil see fossil fuels; lipids
176,213 57,62 organisation of living organisms 26-7
malaria 110, 112, 114
see also sexual reproduc- heterozygous genotype 218-23, malnutrition 62, 68, 69, 268-9 organs and organ systems 27, 73,
tion; zygotes 225,231 101, 144
HIV/AIDS 99, 110, 112, 203, 263 see also deficiency
fertilisers for plants 58-9, 254, 255, diseases origins of life 2, 256
264,269,274-5,283 homeostasis 144-9 osmoregulation 33, 140-2
maltose 40, 76, 78, 79
fetus 196-9 blood glucose 148 mammals, classification 5-6, 14, 15 osmosis 32-3, 73, 88-90, 102-3, 142
fever 110, 147 body temperature 145-7 ovaries
marasmus 63, 69
fibre in diet 62, 65, 70, 73, 76, 78, 298 disease relationship 110 human 166, 167,
marine environments 245, 273,
fish 14, 101,244-5, 275,278-9 internal receptors 160 274,278 188-90, 192--4, 202,213
five kingdoms oflife 5-18, 21 osmoregulation 140-1 mastication 73, 74, 76 plants 179, 182-3
flaccidity/turgidity of plant cells 23, regulatory functions of mathematical skills 314-17 ovemutrition 67-9, 70
33, 50, 89,90 blood 98 measurement of variables 48, 310-12 oviducts 188, 190, 194
flooding 90, 267-9,271 homologous pairs of chromosomes ovulation 190, 192--4
212-13, 218-19,224 meiosis 176,213,218,219,224,231
flowering plants 10-11, 178-87 oxygen
homozygous genotype 218-23, 225, membranes
flowers 11, 54, 178-82, 237 eutrophication 264,
231 of cells 22, 23, 30-5, 102
follicle (Graafian) 192, 193, 195 partially permeable 30, 274-5
food, see also nutrition hormones gas exchange 128, 129,
32,102,142,143
food chains and webs 242-6 birth 200 131
endocrine system 166-9 memory 159
food poisoning 110, 113, 263, 282 menstrual cycle 192-3 population growth 260
food supply 260, 264-9 environmental pollution production by photosyn-
273 mental illness 111 thesis 46, 48-9
food types 63 meristems 86, 212
forests 242-3, 271,276, 284 functions in body 141, respiration 123, 126,
148, 166 mesophyll cells 26, 27, 50, 88-90 127
fossil fuels 52, 252-3, 270-1, 284 metabolism 36, 40, 67, 140-1
glands 166-7 transport in blood
free radicals 111, 117, 135 methane 251,265,270, 271,283-5
menstrual cycle 192-3 96-102, 104-6
fruit/fruiting 54, 173, 178, 182-3, 303 microorganisms see bacteria; fungi;
plants 170-3 oxygen debt 124, 125
fungal diseases 112 pregnancy 193,198 protoctists; yeast oxytocin 200
fungi 4,5, 8-9, 112,250-1, 294-5 microscopes 22, 24, 25
roduction from food
gall bladder 73, 78, 79
molecules 6 f minerals
human nutrition 62, 64
pacemakers 104, 105
puberty 166, 167, 189 pancreas 73, 78, 79,148,149,167
gametes 206 transport in blood 98 plant nutrition 46, 57-9 parasites 17, 18, 110, 112, 223, 246
humans 188, 190, 192, use in sport 168 mitochondria 8, 24, 123, 190
194 partially permeable membranes 30,
human impacts mitosis 176,209,212,214,296 32, 102, 142, 143
plants 10, 26, 178-82 monoclonal antibodies 119, 198
affluence effects 262 pathogens 110,112, 118-19, 197
sexual reproduction deforestation 266-7, monocotyledons 10, 11, 183 penis 98, 188-90, 194
176,177,206,213 270,276,280,284 monoculture 264, 284 peripheral nervous system 154
see also fertilisation; mouth 72-6, 79,116
inheritance; meiosis food webs 244 peristalsis 65, 73, 76, 158, 194
gaseous exchange systems 3, 50-1, pollution 260, 270-5, movement of organisms 2, 3, 122 pesticides 86, 260,264,270, 273,
56, 128-32 276,279 movement in and out of cells 30-5, 279,303
gastric juices 77, 79 positive 276-91 88-9, 102 see also herbicides
since prehistory 262, mucus pH
generation time 261, 292 270
genes alimentary canal 76-8, enzyme activity effects
human population growth 262-5 80 41
coding for proteins 207, hunting endangered animals 276,
208 fish scales 14 indicators 56
277,280,281 from goblet cells 80, 129 regions of gut 73, 76-9
inheritance of character- hydrolysis reactions 36-7, 76, 77,
istics 218-25 in gut 73, 76-8 phagocytes/phagocytosis 34, 97, 98,
251,285 moved by cilia 26, 129 117,118
mutations 6,118,175, hygiene and sanitation 112-14, 175,
196,230-1 respiratory pathways phenotype 219-23,225,229-31
263,282 116, 129, 131, 135
role in disease 106-7, phloem 50, 51, 86, 87
111, 136,222-3,225 hypothalamus 146, 147 muscles 27, 104-6, 122, 124-5, 156-7 photoreceptors 160, 162, 163
gene therapy 302
ileum 73, 79, 80
mutations 6, 118, 175, 230-1 photosynthesis 46-57 317
carbon cycle 252-3 random assortment of alleles 219, sexual reproduction 176-87, 206, urea 81, 140-1
control 52-5 220,231 218-19,231 urethra 140, 188
energy conversions 122 random sampling 247 sickle cell anaemia 99,223,230,231 urine 81, 140-2, 146,273,282
environmental interac- receptors, sensory 145, 147, 154, 157, size of cells 22, 23, 25 urine tests 38, 39, 149, 168, 198, 295
tions 56-7 158, 160-3 skin 14, 21,111, 116, 144, 146-7 urinogenital systems 188, 190
equations 46, 48 recessive alleles 219-23, 225 smoking 132, 134-7, 162, 197 uterus 188,190, 192-8, 200
greenhouses 53-5 recycling soil
leaf structure 50-1 natural cycling of atoms deforestation effects 26 7 vaccination 110-11, 114,119,263,
limiting factors 52-4 and molecules 57, 250-6 minerals/nutrients 46, 304
products 46,47,51,57 waste 286-7 58, 59, 88-9,250,254-5 vacuoles 22, 23
rate measurement 48-9 water 256-7, 282 water 46, 51, 88, 90 vagina 189-90, 192,194,200
requirements 47, 52 red blood cells 26, 33, 81, 97-9, 102, solar energy 46, 122, 242-3, 256, 257 valves 100, 104-6
116, 129 solubility of organic molecules 36-8
phototropism 170-1 variables 49, 310-12
pituitary gland 166, 167, 189, 192, see also haemoglobin species evolution 234-5 variation 2, 228-39
193,200 reflexes 156-7, 159, 163 sperm 26, 167, 188, 190, 192 artificial selection 236-7
placenta 30,119,135, 194-7, 200 refuse, waste management 114-15, sphincters 73, 77, 78, 140
286-7 inheritance 206-7
plants spinal cord and nerves 154, 157, 158 monoculture 264
adaptation to environ- rejection of transplanted tissues 119, starch 23, 36
143,214,217 natural selection 232-5
ment 93 in the diet 63 sexual reproduction
relay neurons 157, 158
agricultural practices digestion 76, 78 177,180,219,231
264, 266-7 renewable fuels 284-5
replication of DNA 209, 212 plant storage 23, 47, 48, vascular tissues in plants 10, 11, 27,
cell division 212 51, 57 51,86-8,90, 93
cells 22, 23, 26-7, 33 reproduction 2, 3, 176-204
test 39, 47 vectors
classification 10-11 fungi 8 starvation see famine; malnutrition of disease 110, 111
crop yields 53, 54, 89, humans 188-204 stem cells 212, 214-17 in genetic engineering
177,264,268 invertebrate animals 13 steroid hormones 63, 168 300,301,302
flower structures 179-81 plants 10, 11, 178-87 veins 96, 100-1
stigma 179-82
genetically modified 303 sexual versus asexual stimuli vena cava 100, 101, 104
hormones/auxins 170-3 176-7
resistance to antibiotics 112, 175, endocrine glands 166 ventilation system 128-30
leaf structure 50-1 plant responses 170-2 vertebrate animals 14-15
mineral deficiencies 59 203,234,265
respiration 2, 3, 122-7 receptors 154,160 villi 80, 197
nutrition 46-61 STis see sexually transmitted infec- viruses 18, 112, 197
aerobic 24, 46, 106,
photosynthesis 46-57 123-6, 184,251,274 tions vision 161-3, 225
poison effects 52 anaerobic 124, 125, 251, stomach 73, 76, 79 vitamins 62, 64, 198, 263, 298
pollination 178-81, 237 252,285,298 stomata 11, 50-2, 88, 90-3 vitamin A 298, 303
reproduction 177-87 blood glucose levels 149 storage molecules 23, 57, 68, 123 vitamin C 39, 64, 69, 74,
respiration 56 carbon cycle 252-3 sucrose, plant transport 52, 57, 86 135, 201
seed banks 277 measurement 126-7 sugars in diet 63, 70, 75 vitamin D 64, 70, 298
selective breeding 54, muscles 124-5 sulfur dioxide 52, 260, 270, 271 voluntary actions 156, 158, 159
237 oxidation 57, 66, 123 surface area effects 30, 31, 51, 80, 93
tissues 27 plants 56 sustainable development 276-7, waste management 114-15, 282-3,
transport systems 86-95 respiratory surface (gas exchange) 280,284 286-7
tropism 170-2 128 swallowing reflex 77, 156 water
see also fruit; seeds responsibility for disease control sweating 142, 146, 147 in blood 97, 98
plasma of blood 64, 97, 98 114-15, 203 synapses 155,157,209 clean and safe 114, 282
platelets 97-9, 116 retina 156, 160, 161-3 decomposition role 251
poisons see toxins ribosomes 210, 211 teeth 15, 70, 74-5 eutrophication 59, 264,
pollination 178-82, 237 rickets 64, 70 temperature 274-5
pollution 260,270-5,276,279 RINGER list of characteristics of decomposition 251 evaporation from leaves
polysaccharides 37, 40, 76, 148 life 2 11,50, 52, 88,90-3
enzyme activity effects
population pyramids 263 RNA (ribonucleic acid) 18, 210-11, 40-1, 52,251 in the gut 78
populations 241 230 heat relationship 146 human requirement 62,
population size and grov.,th 260-4, roots photosynthesis 52-5 64
292 adapted to dry condi- population grov.,th 260 osmoregulation by
positive feedback 274 tions 93 kidneys 140-2
regulating body tem- photosynthesis 46, 50,
practical assessment 306-17 angiosperms 11 perature 15, 145-7
auxins and tropism 170, 51
predators 234, 235, 240, 260 testes 166, 167, 188-90, 192, 194, 213
172 plant needs and regula-
see also carnivores testosterone 166-8, 189, 190 tion 50,52,53
pregnancy 67, 70,140,192, 195-200, ferns 10 tissue fluid 64, 98, 101-3, 140, 142,
food storage 87 properties important to
202 144 life 256
pressure gradients 130, 131 hair cells 26, 87, 88 toxins sewage treatment 282-3
producers and consumers 242-4, 246 internal structure 87 alcohol 298 as a solvent 32, 37
progesterone 167, 192,193,200 mineral ion uptake 31, broken down in liver
34, 52,88, 89 transport through plants
prokaryotes 17 81-2 51,88, 90-1
see also bacteria need for oxygen 59 chemical reagents 309 uptake by roots 86, 88,
protease 77, 78, 79,251,295-6 water uptake 86, 88, 90 crossing placenta 197 90
proteins rough endoplasmic reticulum 24, 211 from pathogens 112, water cycle 256-7
antibodies 118 113 water potential gradient 32, 88,
carriers for active trans- saliva 73, 74, 76, 79 lactic acid 106, 124 90,98
port 34 salt plant effects 52 wavelength of light 49, 52, 54, 243
coded by genes 207, in diet 70 population grov.,th 260 waxy cuticle of plant 50, 51, 91,
208, 210-11,230 osmoregulation 140, radiation 272 93,303
defining characteristics 144 release by microorgan- weather see drought; flooding; global
208,209 in soil 90 isms 73, 100, 112, 113 warming
in the diet 62, 63, 69 sampling, ecological studies 246-9, waste products of me- weed killers (herbicides) 52, 173,
digestion 77-9 260,277 tabolism 140 264,303
functions 63 saprotrophic nutrition 8, 9, 17, 250-1 trachea 77, 129 white blood cells 34, 97-9, 103,
structure 6, 36, 37 saturated fats 63, 70, 106, 201 transamination 81 116-19, 135, 203
synthesis 210-11, 230 scavengers 240, 250 transcription of DNA to RNA 210, World Health Organization (WHO)
test 39 scientific method 312-13 211, 230 114
see also enzymes scurvy 64, 69, 74 transducers of energy 46, 160
protoctists 4, 5, 16, 110, 112, 275 seeds 10-11, 126,178, 182-5, 277 transgenic organisms 302-4 xylem 50, 51, 86-8, 90
puberty 166,167,189 selection pressures 175, 234-7 translation of RNA to protein 210,
pulse/pulse rate 100, 104, 106, 117 selective breeding 54, 236-7, 264-5, 211, 230 yeast 8, 125, 285, 298
pyramids 279 transpiration 50, 88, 90-3 yield of crops 53, 54, 89, 177, 264,
senses and sense organs 158, 160-3 transplants and rejection 119, 143, 268
ecosystem numbers/bio- 214,217
mass/energy 246-7 sensitivity (irritability) 2, 3, 160,
170-2 transport systems 50, 51, 57, 86-95, zygotes 26,176,178,182,183,188,
population by age 263 96-109
sensory receptors 145, 147, 154, 157, 194-6
158, 160-3 trophic levels 242-3, 246-7
qualitative/quantitative assessment of
reactions 48, 92 sewage 274, 275, 282-3 tropism 170-2
qualitative/quantitative characteris- sex chromosomes/sex-linked condi- turgidity/flaccidity of plant cells 23,
tics 228 tions 224-5 33, 50, 89,90
sex hormones see oestrogen; testos- twins 202
radiation terone
heat 146,147,233,271 sex organs 166, 167, 189 umbilical cord 196, 197
sexually transmitted infections (STis) unbalanced diet 68-70
ionising 231, 272 203
solar 91,111,256,271 unsaturated fats 63, 278
318
Cambridge IGCSE & 0 Level Complete Biology directly
matches the latest Cambridge Biology !GCSE (0610) and Empowering every learner to succeed and progress
0 Level (5090) syllabuses, supporting comprehension of
complex ideas and independent learning. A stretching, ✓ Complete Cambridge syllabus match
skills-based approach with a light touch ensures it is Comprehensive exam preparation
engaging, progressively strengthens student ability, Embedded critical thinking skills
and enables confident exam performance.
/ Progression to the next educational stage
• Fully prepare for exams - assessment-focused support Reviewed by international subject specialists
improves students' performance
• Develop advanced skills - a rigorous step-by-step
approach increases students' confidence
• Progress to the next stage - differentiated extension
material eases the transition to 16-18 study
Also available:
978 1382 00575 3 978 1382 00580 7 978 1382 00583 8
11111 111 I
9 781382 005760